]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
gdb/testsuite: fix regressions in break-main-file-remove-fail.exp
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c 87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
3ac23310 88\hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
2d5783fa
NC
464@kindex --enable-linker-version
465@item --enable-linker-version
466Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475@kindex --disable-linker-version
476@item --disable-linker-version
477Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
abf874aa
CL
480@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490@smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
93cda40b
NC
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
abf874aa
CL
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
94ffdb59 499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
abf874aa
CL
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509@end smallexample
510
511This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516This option enables warnings when
517@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520output region.
521
252b5132
RH
522@cindex entry point, from command line
523@kindex -e @var{entry}
524@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 525@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
526@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
b58f81ae
DJ
535@kindex --exclude-libs
536@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 538exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
539@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544be treated as hidden.
545
e1c37eb5
DK
546@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557regardless of this option.
558
252b5132
RH
559@cindex dynamic symbol table
560@kindex -E
561@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 562@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
563@item -E
564@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
565@itemx --no-export-dynamic
566When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
575
576If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579linking the program itself.
580
55255dae 581You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 582be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 583See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 584
8b747e1a
DK
585Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
37a141bf
FS
589@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590@cindex export dynamic symbol
591@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601@cindex export dynamic symbol list
602@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
36f63dca 607@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
608@cindex big-endian objects
609@cindex endianness
610@kindex -EB
611@item -EB
612Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614@cindex little-endian objects
615@kindex -EL
616@item -EL
617Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 618@end ifclear
252b5132 619
2509a395
SL
620@kindex -f @var{name}
621@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622@item -f @var{name}
623@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
624When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 637machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
638
639This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
2509a395
SL
642@kindex -F @var{name}
643@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 644@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 645@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
646When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657@var{name}.
658
ff5dcc92 659Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 660toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
661object files.
662@ifclear SingleFormat
663The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 664@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 665@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
666environment variable.
667@end ifclear
668The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 670
3dbf70a2 671@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
672@kindex -fini=@var{name}
673@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
674When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677the function to call.
678
252b5132
RH
679@kindex -g
680@item -g
681Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
2509a395
SL
683@kindex -G @var{value}
684@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 685@cindex object size
2509a395 686@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
687@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 690MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
691sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 694@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 695@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 696@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
697@itemx -soname=@var{name}
698When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 702field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
703
704@kindex -i
705@cindex incremental link
706@item -i
707Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
3dbf70a2 709@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
710@kindex -init=@var{name}
711@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
712When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715function to call.
716
252b5132 717@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 718@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 719@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 720@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
721@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 725will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 726will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 727
ff5dcc92 728On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
729files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
736
737The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
ff5dcc92 744See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
745archives multiple times.
746
747You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749@ifset GENERIC
750This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 751if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
752behaviour of the AIX linker.
753@end ifset
754
755@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 756@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 757@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 758@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 759@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
760Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
762option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 765@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
766order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768option is specified.
252b5132 769
3aa2d05a
NC
770If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 773
252b5132
RH
774@ifset UsesEnvVars
775The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 776@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
777some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778@end ifset
779
780The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784@cindex emulation
785@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 786@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
787Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794configured.
795
796@cindex link map
797@kindex -M
798@kindex --print-map
799@item -M
800@itemx --print-map
801Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
802information about the link, including the following:
803
804@itemize @bullet
805@item
3b83e13a 806Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
807@item
808How common symbols are allocated.
809@item
810All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
811which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
812@item
813The values assigned to symbols.
814
815Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
816involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
817have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
818linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
819of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
820the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
821linker script containing:
822
823@smallexample
824 foo = 1
825 foo = foo * 4
826 foo = foo + 8
827@end smallexample
828
829will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
830option is used:
831
832@smallexample
833 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
834 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
835 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
836@end smallexample
837
838See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
839scripts.
d2ef37eb 840
06ddcada
AM
841@item
842How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 843
06ddcada
AM
844When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
845.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
846These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
847
848@smallexample
849Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
850@end smallexample
851
06ddcada 852This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
853merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
854is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
855
856@smallexample
06ddcada 857Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
858@end smallexample
859
06ddcada 860This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
861when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
862is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
863@end itemize
864
035801ce
FS
865@cindex link map discarded
866@kindex --print-map-discarded
867@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
868@item --print-map-discarded
869@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
870Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
871in the link map. Enabled by default.
872
496917ce
NC
873@kindex --print-map-locals
874@kindex --no-print-map-locals
875@item --print-map-locals
876@itemx --no-print-map-locals
877Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
878will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
879be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
880Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
881will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
882
252b5132
RH
883@kindex -n
884@cindex read-only text
885@cindex NMAGIC
886@kindex --nmagic
887@item -n
888@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
889Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
890libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
891mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
892
893@kindex -N
894@kindex --omagic
895@cindex read/write from cmd line
896@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 897@item -N
252b5132
RH
898@itemx --omagic
899Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
900not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
901libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
902mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
903is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
904specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
905
906@kindex --no-omagic
907@cindex OMAGIC
908@item --no-omagic
909This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
910sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
911be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
912shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
913
914@kindex -o @var{output}
915@kindex --output=@var{output}
916@cindex naming the output file
917@item -o @var{output}
918@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 919Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
920option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
921script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
922
f37b21b4
RM
923@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
924@cindex dependency file
925@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
926Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
927suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
928that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
929output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
930Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
931Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
932to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
933linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
934@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
935installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
936distributed makefiles without careful editing.
937
252b5132
RH
938@kindex -O @var{level}
939@cindex generating optimized output
940@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 941If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 942the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
943should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
944option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
945the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
946no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
947of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 948
387dd777
DP
949@kindex -plugin @var{name}
950@item -plugin @var{name}
951Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
952the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
953automatically added by the complier, when using link time
954optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
955wish.
956
957Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
958from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
959@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
960those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 961copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 962based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 963just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 964
26278bb8
UD
965@kindex --push-state
966@cindex push state governing input file handling
967@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 968The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
969flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
970restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
971
972The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
973@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
974@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
975@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
976@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
977@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
978
979One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
980used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
981listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
982something as follows:
983
984@smallexample
985-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
986@end smallexample
987
988@kindex --pop-state
989@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 990@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
991Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
992flags governing input file handling.
993
a712da20
NC
994@kindex -q
995@kindex --emit-relocs
996@cindex retain relocations in final executable
997@item -q
998@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 999Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
1000Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1001order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1002in larger executables.
1003
dbab7a7b
NC
1004This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1005
4f471f39
RS
1006@kindex --force-dynamic
1007@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1008@item --force-dynamic
1009Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1010to VxWorks targets.
1011
252b5132
RH
1012@cindex partial link
1013@cindex relocatable output
1014@kindex -r
1049f94e 1015@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 1016@item -r
1049f94e 1017@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 1018Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1019turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
1020linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1021magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1022@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 1023@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
1024If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1025linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1026constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1027
62bf86b4
HPN
1028When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1029partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1030relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1031example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1032with input files in other formats at all.
1033
252b5132
RH
1034This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1035
1036@kindex -R @var{file}
1037@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1038@cindex symbol-only input
1039@item -R @var{filename}
1040@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1041Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1042relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1043to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1044programs. You may use this option more than once.
1045
ff5dcc92 1046For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1047followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1048the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1049
1050@kindex -s
1051@kindex --strip-all
1052@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1053@item -s
252b5132
RH
1054@itemx --strip-all
1055Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1056
1057@kindex -S
1058@kindex --strip-debug
1059@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1060@item -S
252b5132
RH
1061@itemx --strip-debug
1062Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1063
a70f34c0
NC
1064@kindex --strip-discarded
1065@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1066@item --strip-discarded
1067@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1068Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1069Enabled by default.
1070
252b5132
RH
1071@kindex -t
1072@kindex --trace
1073@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1074@item -t
252b5132 1075@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1076Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1077@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1078@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1079and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1080a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1081
1082@kindex -T @var{script}
1083@kindex --script=@var{script}
1084@cindex script files
1085@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1086@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1087Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
31f14901
AM
1088@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1089unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
252b5132 1090@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1091output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1092the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1093specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1094options accumulate.
252b5132 1095
14be8564
L
1096@kindex -dT @var{script}
1097@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1098@cindex script files
1099@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1100@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1101Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1102
1103This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1104processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1105command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1106@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1107behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1108command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1109the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1110@samp{gcc}).
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1113@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1114@cindex undefined symbol
1115@item -u @var{symbol}
1116@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1117Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1118symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1119modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1120different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1121option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1122
0a618243
AB
1123If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1124into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1125undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1126instead.
1127
1128@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1129@cindex symbols, require defined
1130@cindex defined symbol
1131@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1132Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1133is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1134is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1135and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1136@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1137can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1138
252b5132
RH
1139@kindex -Ur
1140@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1141@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1142For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1143@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1144turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1145@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1146It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1147with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1148be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1149@samp{-r} for the others.
1150
c005eb9e
AB
1151@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1152@cindex orphan sections
1153@cindex sections, orphan
1154@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1155Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1156specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1157
1158@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1159
1160@table @code
1161@item place
1162Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1163the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1164@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1165
1166@item discard
1167All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1168@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1169
1170@item warn
1171The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1172issue a warning.
1173
1174@item error
1175The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1176@end table
1177
1178The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1179
577a0623
AM
1180@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1181@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1182Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1183@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1184missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1185specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1186multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1187input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1188in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1189
252b5132
RH
1190@kindex -v
1191@kindex -V
1192@kindex --version
1193@cindex version
1194@item -v
1195@itemx --version
1196@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1197Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
2d5783fa
NC
1198lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1199@option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1200which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
252b5132
RH
1201
1202@kindex -x
1203@kindex --discard-all
1204@cindex deleting local symbols
1205@item -x
1206@itemx --discard-all
1207Delete all local symbols.
1208
1209@kindex -X
1210@kindex --discard-locals
1211@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1212@item -X
252b5132 1213@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1214Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1215system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1216or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1217
1218@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1219@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1220@cindex symbol tracing
1221@item -y @var{symbol}
1222@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1223Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1224option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1225to prepend an underscore.
1226
1227This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1228don't know where the reference is coming from.
1229
1230@kindex -Y @var{path}
1231@item -Y @var{path}
1232Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1233for Solaris compatibility.
1234
1235@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1236@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1237The recognized keywords are:
1238@table @samp
1239
e6e2dfbd
AM
1240@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1241@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1242@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1243@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1244Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1245to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1246@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1247@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1248@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1249@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1250Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1251
233a0083
L
1252@item cet-report=none
1253@itemx cet-report=warning
1254@itemx cet-report=error
1255Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1256GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1257section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1258linker not report missing properties in input files.
1259@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1260missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1261the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1262Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1263GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1264turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1265Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1266
cd6d6c15 1267@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1268@itemx nocombreloc
1269Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1270dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1271
b8871f35 1272@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1273@itemx nocommon
1274Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1275link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1276
1277@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1278Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1279layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1280using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1281
cd6d6c15 1282@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1283Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1284is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1285This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1288@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1289Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1290if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1291by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1292@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1293may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1294selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1295these options.
1296
6aa29e7b
JJ
1297@item execstack
1298Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1299
b039ef04
L
1300@item global
1301This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1302the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1303of subsequently loaded libraries.
1304
93ab9c0d
NC
1305@item globalaudit
1306This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1307This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1308setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1309tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1310the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1311all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1312
e6e2dfbd
AM
1313@item ibtplt
1314Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1315Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1316
8df93cb5 1317@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1318Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1319to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1320Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1321
6f365fda
L
1322@item indirect-extern-access
1323@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1325.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1326canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1327This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1328@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1329
1330@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1331GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1332section.
1333
cd6d6c15
NC
1334@item initfirst
1335This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1336It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1337before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1338the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1339the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1340objects.
1341
1342@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1344so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1345libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1346
c3805e4c
VDM
1347@item unique
1348@itemx nounique
1349When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1350object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1351and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1352primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1353al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1354of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1355and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1356
279d901e
L
1357@item lam-u48
1358Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1359to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1360
1361@item lam-u57
1362Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1363to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1364
1365@item lam-u48-report=none
1366@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1367@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1368Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1369property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1370@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1371linker not report missing properties in input files.
1372@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1373missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1374make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1375Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1376
1377@item lam-u57-report=none
1378@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1379@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1380Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1381property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1382@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1383linker not report missing properties in input files.
1384@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1385missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1386make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1387Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1388
1389@item lam-report=none
1390@itemx lam-report=warning
1391@itemx lam-report=error
1392Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1393GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1394section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1395linker not report missing properties in input files.
1396@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1397missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1398the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1399Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1400
5fa222e4
AM
1401@item lazy
1402When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1403dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1404the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1405Lazy binding is the default.
1406
cd6d6c15 1407@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1408Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1411Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1412
e6e2dfbd
AM
1413@item muldefs
1414Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1415
cd6d6c15 1416@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1417Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1418defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1419
1420@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1421Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1422should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1423
1424@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1425Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1426
1427@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1428Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1429
1430@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1431Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1432
6aa29e7b
JJ
1433@item noexecstack
1434Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1435
e6e2dfbd
AM
1436@item noextern-protected-data
1437Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1438library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1439used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1440generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1441module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1442i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1443
e6e2dfbd
AM
1444@item noreloc-overflow
1445Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1446relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1447overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1448
cd6d6c15
NC
1449@item now
1450When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1451dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1452when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1453function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1454called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1455
1456@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1457Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1458
6a91be86
L
1459@item pack-relative-relocs
1460@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1461Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1462and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1463@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1464building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1465@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1466relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1467GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1468added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1469
6aa29e7b 1470@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1471@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1472Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1473specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1474relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1475than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1476Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1477
68b00778
L
1478@item report-relative-reloc
1479Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1480Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1481
47acac12
L
1482@item separate-code
1483@itemx noseparate-code
1484Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1485specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1486be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1487code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1488
e6e2dfbd
AM
1489@item shstk
1490Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1491to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1492Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1493
04c3a755 1494@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1495Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1496Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1497@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1498
8ee10e86
AM
1499@item start-stop-gc
1500@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1501@cindex start-stop-gc
1502When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1503section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1504input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1505@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1506@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1507linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1508sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1509were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1510definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1511object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1512linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1513@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1514treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1515
cae64165
RM
1516@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1517@cindex visibility
1518@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1519Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1520@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1521Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1522@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1523start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1524compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1525recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1526programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1527between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1528
e6e2dfbd
AM
1529@item text
1530@itemx notext
1531@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1532Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1533or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1534report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1535
97a232d7
NC
1536@item undefs
1537Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1538either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1539This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1540
2d95647b
L
1541@item unique-symbol
1542@itemx nounique-symbol
1543Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1544".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1545is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1546
b0ab0693 1547@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1548@item x86-64-v2
1549@item x86-64-v3
1550@itemx x86-64-v4
1551Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1552@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1553@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1554@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1555@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1556Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1557
cd6d6c15
NC
1558@end table
1559
ece2d90e 1560Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1561
1562@kindex -(
1563@cindex groups of archives
1564@item -( @var{archives} -)
1565@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1566The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1567either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1568
1569The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1570references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1571the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1572archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1573object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1574would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1575they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1576resolved.
1577
1578Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1579it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1580more archives.
1581
69da35b5
NC
1582@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1583@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1584@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1585@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1586Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1587recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1588and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1589the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1590behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1591so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1592restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1593
4a43e768
AM
1594@kindex --as-needed
1595@kindex --no-as-needed
1596@item --as-needed
1597@itemx --no-as-needed
1598This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1599on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1600the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1601on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1602needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1603emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1604non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1605the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1606non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1607Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1608the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1609needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1610from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1611
6418520e
NC
1612Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1613an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1614@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1615@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1616
e56f61be
L
1617@kindex --add-needed
1618@kindex --no-add-needed
1619@item --add-needed
1620@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1621These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1622their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1623options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1624and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1625
252b5132
RH
1626@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1627@item -assert @var{keyword}
1628This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1629
1630@kindex -Bdynamic
1631@kindex -dy
1632@kindex -call_shared
1633@item -Bdynamic
1634@itemx -dy
1635@itemx -call_shared
1636Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1637for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1638default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1639for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1640multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1641@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1642
a1ab1d2a
UD
1643@kindex -Bgroup
1644@item -Bgroup
1645Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1646section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1647object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1648@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1649only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1650
252b5132
RH
1651@kindex -Bstatic
1652@kindex -dn
1653@kindex -non_shared
1654@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1655@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1656@itemx -dn
1657@itemx -non_shared
1658@itemx -static
1659Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1660platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1661variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1662may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1663library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1664option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1665option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1666shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1667references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1668libraries.
252b5132
RH
1669
1670@kindex -Bsymbolic
1671@item -Bsymbolic
1672When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1673definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1674for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1675within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1676platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1677
40b36307
L
1678@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1679@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1680When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1681symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1682This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1683libraries.
40b36307 1684
cf893b0e
FS
1685@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1686@item -Bno-symbolic
1687This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1688@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1689
55255dae
L
1690@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1691@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1692Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1693typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1694global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1695within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1696to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1697in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1698which support shared libraries.
1699
1700The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1701scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1702
40b36307
L
1703@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1704@item --dynamic-list-data
1705Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1706
1707@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1708@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1709Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1710is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1711
0b8a70d9
L
1712@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1713@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1714Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1715
252b5132
RH
1716@kindex --check-sections
1717@kindex --no-check-sections
1718@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1719@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1720Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1721been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1722perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1723suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1724allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1725restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1726Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1727force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1728option.
252b5132 1729
ddbb8a31
NC
1730@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1731@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1732@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1733@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1734This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1735by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1736command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1737output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1738input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1739specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1740follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1741behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1742
1743This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1744libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1745mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1746their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1747required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1748the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1749dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1750symbols.
1751
252b5132
RH
1752@cindex cross reference table
1753@kindex --cref
1754@item --cref
1755Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1756generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1757Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1758
1759The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1760easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1761sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1762symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1763definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1764where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1765symbol are listed.
252b5132 1766
5dba6f05
NA
1767@cindex ctf variables
1768@kindex --ctf-variables
1769@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1770@item --ctf-variables
1771@item --no-ctf-variables
1772The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1773types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1774table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1775conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1776usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1777@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1778The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1779
1780@cindex ctf type sharing
1781@kindex --ctf-share-types
1782@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1783Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1784
1785@table @samp
1786@item share-unconflicted
1787Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1788where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1789translation unit. This is the default.
1790
1791@item share-duplicated
1792Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1793dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1794dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1795always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1796larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1797large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1798consumer at runtime.
1799@end table
1800
4818e05f
AM
1801@cindex common allocation
1802@kindex --no-define-common
1803@item --no-define-common
1804This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1805The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1806@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1807
1808The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1809the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1810of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1811forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1812Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1813from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1814This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1815and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1816duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1817paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1818
7bdf4127
AB
1819@cindex group allocation in linker script
1820@cindex section groups
1821@cindex COMDAT
1822@kindex --force-group-allocation
1823@item --force-group-allocation
1824This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1825normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1826default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1827change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1828command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1829effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1830
252b5132 1831@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1832@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1833@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1834Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1835address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1836times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1837limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1838context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1839symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1840constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1841using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1842@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1843equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1844
54874444
AB
1845The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1846in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1847symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1848placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1849the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1850consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1851@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1852you are trying to achieve.
1853
252b5132 1854@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1855@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1856@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1857@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1858@itemx --no-demangle
1859These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1860and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1861present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1862underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1863mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1864different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1865to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1866demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1867is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1868
1869@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1870@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1871@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1872@item -I@var{file}
1873@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1874Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1875generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1876linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1877doing.
1878
9b8b325a
RF
1879@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1880@item --no-dynamic-linker
1881When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1882linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1883executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1884entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1885
a70f34c0
NC
1886@kindex --embedded-relocs
1887@item --embedded-relocs
1888This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1889that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1890is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1891targets.
1892
3f0a5f17
ME
1893@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1894@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1895Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1896in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1897
7ce691ae 1898@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1899@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1900@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1901@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1902Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1903with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1904
4b2e7a57
NC
1905@kindex -w
1906@kindex --no-warnings
1907@item -w
1908@itemx --no-warnings
1909Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1910@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1911used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1912is still a need to create it.
1913
252b5132
RH
1914@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1915@item --force-exe-suffix
1916Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1917
1918If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1919@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1920the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1921option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1922Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1923it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1924
1925@kindex --gc-sections
1926@kindex --no-gc-sections
1927@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1928@item --gc-sections
1929@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1930Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1931targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1932performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1933@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1934collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1935implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1936
d5465ba2
AM
1937@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1938examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1939symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1940command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1941referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1942libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1943referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1944the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1945relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1946@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1947
ac69cbc6 1948This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1949@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1950specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1951@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1952command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1953
99fabbc9
JL
1954As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1955@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1956
c17d87de
NC
1957@kindex --print-gc-sections
1958@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1959@cindex garbage collection
1960@item --print-gc-sections
1961@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1962List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1963printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1964collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1965default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1966be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1967line.
1968
22185505 1969@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1970@cindex garbage collection
1971@item --gc-keep-exported
1972When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1973collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1974default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1975executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1976collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1977Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1978it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1979ELF format targets.
1980
30824704
RM
1981@kindex --print-output-format
1982@cindex output format
1983@item --print-output-format
1984Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1985other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1986in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1987
3604cb1f
TG
1988@kindex --print-memory-usage
1989@cindex memory usage
1990@item --print-memory-usage
1991Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1992the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1993quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1994headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1995parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1996
1997@smallexample
1998Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1999 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2000 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2001@end smallexample
2002
252b5132
RH
2003@cindex help
2004@cindex usage
2005@kindex --help
2006@item --help
2007Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2008
ea20a7da
CC
2009@kindex --target-help
2010@item --target-help
a094d01f 2011Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 2012
2509a395
SL
2013@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2014@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 2015Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
2016@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2017@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2018
2019Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2020written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2021inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2022file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2023@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2024output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2025@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2026
2027@smallexample
2028 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2029 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2030 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2031 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2032 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2033 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2034 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2035 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2036 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2037 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2038@end smallexample
2039
2040It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2041
2042If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2043operation.
252b5132
RH
2044
2045@cindex memory usage
2046@kindex --no-keep-memory
2047@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2048@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2049symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2050instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2051necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2052while linking a large executable.
2053
2054@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2055@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2056@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2057@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2058@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2059Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2060is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2061The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2062behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2063libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2064
97a232d7
NC
2065The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2066
aa713662
L
2067@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2068@kindex -z muldefs
2069@item --allow-multiple-definition
2070@itemx -z muldefs
2071Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2072report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2073first definition will be used.
2074
b79e8c78 2075@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2076@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2077@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2078@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2079Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2080This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2081determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2082shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2083how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2084
903249d7
NC
2085The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2086referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2087an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2088a shared library.
2089
2090The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2091libraries specified at link time are that:
2092
2093@itemize @bullet
2094@item
2095A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2096that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2097resolvable at load time.
2098@item
2099There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2100symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2101
2102The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2103select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2104architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2105appropriate memset function.
2106@end itemize
b79e8c78 2107
23ae20f5
NC
2108@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2109@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2110If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2111@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2112only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2113libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2114``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2115undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2116will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2117might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2118error message will be displayed.
2119
2120The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2121switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2122
31941635
L
2123@kindex --no-undefined-version
2124@item --no-undefined-version
2125Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2126it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2127will be issued instead.
2128
3e3b46e5
PB
2129@kindex --default-symver
2130@item --default-symver
2131Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2132exported symbols.
2133
2134@kindex --default-imported-symver
2135@item --default-imported-symver
2136Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2137imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2138
252b5132
RH
2139@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2140@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2141Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2142files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2143been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2144This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2145errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2146have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2147inappropriate.
2148
fe7929ce
AM
2149@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2150@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2151Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2152library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2153
252b5132
RH
2154@kindex --no-whole-archive
2155@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2156Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2157archive files.
2158
2159@cindex output file after errors
2160@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2161@item --noinhibit-exec
2162Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2163Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2164errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2165when it issues any error whatsoever.
2166
0a9c1c8e
CD
2167@kindex -nostdlib
2168@item -nostdlib
2169Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2170command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2171(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2172
252b5132 2173@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2174@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2175@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2176@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2177file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2178@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2179object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2180object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2181should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2182usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2183name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2184list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2185command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2186this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2187@end ifclear
2188
76359541
TP
2189@kindex --out-implib
2190@item --out-implib @var{file}
2191Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2192the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2193library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2194may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2195behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2196step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2197the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2198
36af4a4e
JJ
2199@kindex -pie
2200@kindex --pic-executable
2201@item -pie
2202@itemx --pic-executable
2203@cindex position independent executables
2204Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2205ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2206libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2207address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2208normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2209defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2210
e8f6c2a5
FS
2211@kindex -no-pie
2212@item -no-pie
2213@cindex position dependent executables
2214Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2215
252b5132
RH
2216@kindex -qmagic
2217@item -qmagic
2218This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2219
2220@kindex -Qy
2221@item -Qy
2222This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2223
2224@kindex --relax
2225@cindex synthesizing linker
2226@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2227@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2228@item --relax
28d5f677 2229@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2230An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2231@ifset GENERIC
2232This option is only supported on a few targets.
2233@end ifset
2234@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2235@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2236@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2237@ifset XTENSA
2238@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2239@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2240@ifset M68HC11
2241@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2242@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2243@ifset NIOSII
2244@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2245@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2246@ifset POWERPC
2247@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2248@end ifset
252b5132 2249
ccd9fae5 2250On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2251global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2252addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2253synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2254instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2255
2256On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2257debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2258@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2259This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2260family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2261@end ifset
2262
ccd9fae5
NC
2263On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2264@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2265
ccd9fae5
NC
2266On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2267and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2268
252b5132
RH
2269@cindex retaining specified symbols
2270@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2271@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2272@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2273@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2274Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2275discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2276symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2277@ifset GENERIC
2278(such as VxWorks)
2279@end ifset
2280where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2281run-time memory.
2282
2283@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2284or symbols needed for relocations.
2285
2286You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2287line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2288
2289@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2290@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2291@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2292@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2293Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2294linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2295arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2296them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2297
2298The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2299are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2300description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2301in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2302have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2303
2304If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2305contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2306is defined.
252b5132 2307
ff5dcc92 2308The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2309SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2310@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2311runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2312options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2313gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2314file systems.
252b5132 2315
ff5dcc92 2316For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2317followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2318the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2319@end ifset
2320
2321@ifset GENERIC
2322@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2323@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2324@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2325When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2326happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2327of the input files.
2328
2329When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2330non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2331shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2332explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2333specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2334@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2335either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2336appearing multiple times.
2337
e680a6b6
NC
2338The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2339directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2340containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2341and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
234264-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2343
2344The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2345@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2346supported.
2347
28c309a2
NC
2348This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2349that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2350is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2351runtime linker would do.
2352
252b5132 2353The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2354libraries:
d8e4137b 2355
252b5132
RH
2356@enumerate
2357@item
ff5dcc92 2358Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2359@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2360Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2361between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2362specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2363used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2364at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2365by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2366the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2367@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2368On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2369@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2370environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2371@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2372On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2373directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2374@item
a1b8d843 2375For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2376variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2377@item
ec4eb78a
L
2378For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2379@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2380libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2381@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2382@item
d8e4137b
NC
2383For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2384exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2385to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2386defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2387configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2388@item
2389For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2390the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2391header file.
2392@item
364d7729
AM
2393Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2394linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2395by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2396@item
2397The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2398@item
2399Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2400@item
2401Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2402linker script.
252b5132
RH
2403@end enumerate
2404
6418520e
NC
2405Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2406the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2407is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2408library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2409@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2410directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2411this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2412@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2413of the first.
2414
252b5132
RH
2415If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2416warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2417
252b5132
RH
2418@end ifset
2419
2420@kindex -shared
2421@kindex -Bshareable
2422@item -shared
2423@itemx -Bshareable
2424@cindex shared libraries
2425Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2426and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2427shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2428undefined symbols in the link.
2429
252b5132 2430@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2431@item --sort-common
2432@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2433@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2434This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2435ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2436sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2437eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2438between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2439specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2440
2509a395
SL
2441@kindex --sort-section=name
2442@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2443This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2444patterns in the linker script.
2445
2509a395
SL
2446@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2447@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2448This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2449patterns in the linker script.
2450
a70f34c0
NC
2451@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2452@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2453This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2454.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2455post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2456
252b5132 2457@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2458@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2459Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2460each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2461size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2462
2463@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2464@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2465Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2466output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2467This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2468certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2469cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2470that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2471support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2472input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2473more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2474many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2475
2476@kindex --stats
2477@item --stats
2478Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2479as execution time and memory usage.
2480
2509a395 2481@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2482@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2483Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2484configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2485that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2486
a70f34c0
NC
2487@kindex --task-link
2488@item --task-link
2489This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2490file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2491
252b5132
RH
2492@kindex --traditional-format
2493@cindex traditional format
2494@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2495For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2496the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2497use the traditional format instead.
2498
2499@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2500For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2501symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2502full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2503@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2504trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2505combine duplicate entries.
2506
2509a395
SL
2507@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2508@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2509Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2510address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2511times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2512line.
2513@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2514for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2515@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2516should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2517sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2518
2509a395
SL
2519@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2520@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2521@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2522@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2523@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2524@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2525@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2526Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2527@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2528
2509a395
SL
2529@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2530@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2531@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2532When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2533byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2534
9d5777a3
RM
2535@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2536@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2537@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2538When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2539the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2540text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2541
0d705e9f
AM
2542@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2543@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2544@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2545When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2546model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2547
560e09e9
NC
2548@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2549@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2550Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2551values for @samp{method}:
2552
2553@table @samp
2554@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2555Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2556
2557@item report-all
da8bce14 2558Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2559
2560@item ignore-in-object-files
2561Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2562ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2563
2564@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2565Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2566ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2567when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2568libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2569command line.
2570@end table
2571
2572The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2573by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2574
2575Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2576unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2577can change this to a warning.
2578
1715a13c
L
2579@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2580@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2581@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2582@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2583Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2584supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2585the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2586argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2587
2588@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2589@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2590@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2591Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2592used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2593about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2594is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2595see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2596use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2597symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2598@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2599
7ce691ae 2600@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2601@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2602@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2603@item --warn-common
2604Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2605a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2606but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2607you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2608Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2609warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2610
2611There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2612
2613@table @samp
2614@item int i = 1;
2615A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2616file.
2617
2618@item extern int i;
2619An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2620There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2621variable somewhere.
2622
2623@item int i;
2624A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2625variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2626The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2627single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2628size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2629a definition of the same variable.
2630@end table
2631
2632The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2633Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2634just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2635encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2636a common symbol.
2637
2638@enumerate
2639@item
2640Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2641definition for the symbol.
2642@smallexample
2643@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2644 overridden by definition
2645@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2646@end smallexample
2647
2648@item
2649Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2650the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2651except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2652@smallexample
2653@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2654 overriding common
2655@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2656@end smallexample
2657
2658@item
2659Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2660@smallexample
2661@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2662 of `@var{symbol}'
2663@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2664@end smallexample
2665
2666@item
2667Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2668@smallexample
2669@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2670 overridden by larger common
2671@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2672@end smallexample
2673
2674@item
2675Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2676the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2677encountered in a different order.
2678@smallexample
2679@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2680 overriding smaller common
2681@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2682@end smallexample
2683@end enumerate
2684
2685@kindex --warn-constructors
2686@item --warn-constructors
2687Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2688object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2689detect the use of global constructors.
2690
65daf5be 2691@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2692@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2693@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2694@item --warn-execstack
2695@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2696On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2697messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2698default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2699line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2700@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2701
2702On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2703executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2704stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2705noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2706can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2707
2708Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2709stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2710bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2711an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2712flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2713section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2714some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2715executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2716crafted assembler files.
2717
252b5132
RH
2718@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2719@item --warn-multiple-gp
2720Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2721This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2722Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2723section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2724of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2725base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2726base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2727bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2728large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2729values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2730option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2731
2732@kindex --warn-once
2733@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2734@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2735@item --warn-once
2736Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2737which refers to it.
2738
ba951afb
NC
2739@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2740@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2741@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2742@item --warn-rwx-segments
2743@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2744Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2745all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2746segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2747warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2748created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2749not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2750
2751These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2752@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2753@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2754
252b5132
RH
2755@kindex --warn-section-align
2756@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2757@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2758@item --warn-section-align
2759Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2760alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2761The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2762is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2763the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2764
a6dbf402
L
2765@kindex --warn-textrel
2766@item --warn-textrel
2767Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2768or shared object.
8fdd7217 2769
a0c402a5
L
2770@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2771@item --warn-alternate-em
2772Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2773
560e09e9
NC
2774@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2775@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2776If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2777@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2778This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2779
2780@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2781@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2782This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2783it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2784
252b5132
RH
2785@kindex --whole-archive
2786@cindex including an entire archive
2787@item --whole-archive
2788For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2789@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2790in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2791files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2792library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2793library. This option may be used more than once.
2794
7ec229ce 2795Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2796about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2797Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2798list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2799your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2800
2509a395
SL
2801@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2802@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2803Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2804@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2805undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2806@var{symbol}.
2807
2808This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2809wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2810wishes to call the system function, it should call
2811@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2812
2813Here is a trivial example:
2814
2815@smallexample
2816void *
cc2f008e 2817__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2818@{
cc2f008e 2819 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2820 return __real_malloc (c);
2821@}
2822@end smallexample
2823
ff5dcc92 2824If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2825all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2826instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2827call the real @code{malloc} function.
2828
2829You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2830links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2831you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2832file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2833call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2834
4ea904ed
SH
2835Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2836internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2837@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2838@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2839
2840@smallexample
2841int
2842f (void)
2843@{
2844 return 123;
2845@}
2846
2847int
2848g (void)
2849@{
2850 return f();
2851@}
2852@end smallexample
2853
6aa29e7b 2854@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2855@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2856@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2857@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2858Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2859(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2860section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2861
e41b3a13
JJ
2862@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2863@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2864Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2865generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b 2866if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
1bd123bd 2867controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
cf0e0a0b 2868generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2869
6c1439be
L
2870@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2871@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2872@item --enable-new-dtags
2873@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2874This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2875systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2876@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2877and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2878If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2879created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2880those options are only available for ELF systems.
2881
2d643429 2882@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2883@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2884Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2885close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2886time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2887increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2888value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2889
fdc90cb4
JJ
2890@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2891@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2892Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2893@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2894new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2895the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2896hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2897but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2898
0ce398f1
L
2899@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2900@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2901@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2902@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2903@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2904@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2905@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2906@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2907@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2908@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2909On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2910compressed using zlib.
2911
2912@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2913sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2914DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2915instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2916also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2917sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2918
2919The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2920@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2921
2cac01e3
FS
2922@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2923zstd.
2924
9af89fba
NC
2925Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2926sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2927for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2928uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2929
2930The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2931involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2932default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2933@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2934
35835446
JR
2935@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2936@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2937This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2938linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2939for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2940about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2941
4f9c04f7 2942Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 29431021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2944run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2945has been used.
2946
2947The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2948enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2949
a8dde0a2
L
2950@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2951@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2952@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2953of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2954maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2955
c0065db7
RM
2956@kindex --build-id
2957@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2958@item --build-id
2959@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2960Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2961or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2962unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2963@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2964@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2965@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2966the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2967string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2968@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2969is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2970
2971The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2972that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2973unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2974to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2975file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2976string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2977
2978Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2979@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
2980
2981@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2982@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2983Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
2984contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2985specification. For more information see:
2986https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2987If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2988creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2989occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2990If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2991will be validated.
252b5132
RH
2992@end table
2993
0285c67d
NC
2994@c man end
2995
36f63dca 2996@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2997
0285c67d
NC
2998@c man begin OPTIONS
2999
ff5dcc92 3000The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
3001the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3002normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3003use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3004@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3005like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3006symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3007object file).
3008
3009In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 3010support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
3011PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3012values by either a space or an equals sign.
3013
ff5dcc92 3014@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
3015
3016@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3017@item --add-stdcall-alias
3018If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3019as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 3020[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3021
3022@kindex --base-file
3023@item --base-file @var{file}
3024Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3025addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3026@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 3027[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
3028
3029@kindex --dll
3030@item --dll
3031Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3032@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3033file.
bb10df36 3034[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3035
88183869
DK
3036@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3037@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3038@item --enable-long-section-names
3039@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3040The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3041the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3042for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3043fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3044to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3045allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3046disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3047generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3048as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3049with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3050GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3051information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3052option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3053section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3054when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3055image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3056[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3057
252b5132
RH
3058@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3059@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3060@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3061@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3062If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3063do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3064only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3065resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3066undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3067@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3068to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3069warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3070import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3071to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3072feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3073@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3074mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3075[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3076
522f09cd
KT
3077@kindex --leading-underscore
3078@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3079@item --leading-underscore
3080@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3081For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3082in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3083disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3084
252b5132
RH
3085@cindex DLLs, creating
3086@kindex --export-all-symbols
3087@item --export-all-symbols
3088If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3089be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3090otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3091explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3092attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3093option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3094@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3095@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3096exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3097re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3098such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3099@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3100@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3101Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3102not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3103extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3104(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3105These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3106@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3107@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3108@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3109@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3110[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3111
3112@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3113@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3114Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3115exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3116[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3117
2927aaca
NC
3118@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3119@item --exclude-all-symbols
3120Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3121[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3122
252b5132
RH
3123@kindex --file-alignment
3124@item --file-alignment
3125Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3126file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3127512.
bb10df36 3128[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3129
3130@cindex heap size
3131@kindex --heap
3132@item --heap @var{reserve}
3133@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3134Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3135to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3136committed.
bb10df36 3137[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3138
3139@cindex image base
3140@kindex --image-base
3141@item --image-base @var{value}
3142Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3143the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3144is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3145your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3146other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3147for dlls.
bb10df36 3148[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3149
3150@kindex --kill-at
3151@item --kill-at
3152If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3153symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3154[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3155
26d2d8a2
BF
3156@kindex --large-address-aware
3157@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3158If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3159header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3160greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3161or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3162section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3163[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3164
f69a2f97
NC
3165@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3166@item --disable-large-address-aware
3167Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3168This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3169driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3170addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3171[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3172
252b5132
RH
3173@kindex --major-image-version
3174@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3175Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3176[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3177
3178@kindex --major-os-version
3179@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3180Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3181[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3182
3183@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3184@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3185Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3186[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3187
3188@kindex --minor-image-version
3189@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3190Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3191[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3192
3193@kindex --minor-os-version
3194@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3195Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3196[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3197
3198@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3199@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3200Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3201[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3202
3203@cindex DEF files, creating
3204@cindex DLLs, creating
3205@kindex --output-def
3206@item --output-def @var{file}
3207The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3208file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3209(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3210library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3211automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3212[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3213
b044cda1 3214@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3215@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3216@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3217@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3218Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3219@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3220By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3221for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3222execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3223[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3224
3225@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3226@item --disable-auto-image-base
3227Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3228user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3229default.
bb10df36 3230[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3231
3232@cindex DLLs, linking to
3233@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3234@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3235When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3236search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3237@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3238between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3239uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3240@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3241[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3242
3243@kindex --enable-auto-import
3244@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3245Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3246DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3247mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3248[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3249
3250The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3251feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3252
3253Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3254of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3255PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3256
e2a83dd0
NC
3257Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3258data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3259placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3260around a problem with consts that is described here:
3261http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3262
4d8907ac
DS
3263Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3264see this message:
0d888aac 3265
ece2d90e 3266"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3267documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3268
ece2d90e
NC
3269This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3270ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3271allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3272fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3273constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3274multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3275this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3276of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3277the warning, and exit.
3278
3279There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3280data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3281
2fa9fc65
NC
3282One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3283of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3284this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3285
c0065db7
RM
3286A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3287that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3288there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3289a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3290
3291@example
3292extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3293extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3294 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3295@end example
3296
3297or
3298
3299@example
3300extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3301extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3302 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3303@end example
3304
c0065db7 3305For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3306is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3307
3308@example
3309extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3310extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3311 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3312@end example
3313
c406afaf
NC
3314or
3315
3316@example
3317extern long long extern_ll;
3318extern_ll -->
3319 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3320@end example
3321
2fa9fc65 3322A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3323'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3324@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3325requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3326building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3327merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3328between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3329constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3330
3331Original:
3332@example
3333--foo.h
3334extern int arr[];
3335--foo.c
3336#include "foo.h"
3337void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3338 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3339@}
3340@end example
3341
3342Solution 1:
3343@example
3344--foo.h
3345extern int arr[];
3346--foo.c
3347#include "foo.h"
3348void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3349 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3350 volatile int *parr = arr;
3351 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3352@}
3353@end example
3354
3355Solution 2:
3356@example
3357--foo.h
3358/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3359#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3360 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3361#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3362#else
3363#define FOO_IMPORT
3364#endif
3365extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3366--foo.c
3367#include "foo.h"
3368void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3369 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3370@}
3371@end example
3372
c0065db7 3373A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3374library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3375for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3376functions).
b044cda1
CW
3377
3378@kindex --disable-auto-import
3379@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3380Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3381@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3382[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3383
2fa9fc65
NC
3384@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3385@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3386If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3387that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3388a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3389environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3390[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3391
3392@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3393@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3394Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3395[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3396
b044cda1
CW
3397@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3398@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3399Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3400[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3401
252b5132
RH
3402@kindex --section-alignment
3403@item --section-alignment
3404Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3405addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3406[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3407
3408@cindex stack size
3409@kindex --stack
3410@item --stack @var{reserve}
3411@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3412Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3413to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3414committed.
bb10df36 3415[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3416
3417@kindex --subsystem
3418@item --subsystem @var{which}
3419@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3420@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3421Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3422legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3423@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3424the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3425@var{which}.
bb10df36 3426[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3427
2f563b51
DK
3428The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3429of the PE file header:
3430[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3431
2d5c3743
NC
3432@kindex --high-entropy-va
3433@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3434@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3435Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3436(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3437
dc9bd8c9
HD
3438This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3439@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3440
2f563b51
DK
3441@kindex --dynamicbase
3442@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3443@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3444The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3445randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3446Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3447can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3448This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3449
3450@kindex --forceinteg
3451@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3452@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3453Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3454default.
2f563b51
DK
3455
3456@kindex --nxcompat
3457@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3458@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3459The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3460This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3461targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3462
3463@kindex --no-isolation
3464@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3465@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3466Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3467This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3468
3469@kindex --no-seh
3470@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3471@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3472The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3473this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3474
3475@kindex --no-bind
3476@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3477@itemx --disable-no-bind
3478Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3479
3480@kindex --wdmdriver
3481@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3482@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3483The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3484by default.
9d5777a3 3485
2f563b51
DK
3486@kindex --tsaware
3487@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3488@itemx --disable-tsaware
3489The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3490default.
2f563b51 3491
0cb112f7
CF
3492@kindex --insert-timestamp
3493@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3494@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3495Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3496as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3497other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3498will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3499same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3500can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3501that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3502identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3503
3504@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3505@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3506@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3507Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3508is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3509This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3510@end table
3511
0285c67d
NC
3512@c man end
3513
ac145307
BS
3514@ifset C6X
3515@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3516
3517@c man begin OPTIONS
3518
3519The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3520libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3521all executables use an index of 0.
3522
3523@table @gcctabopt
3524
3525@kindex --dsbt-size
3526@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3527This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3528or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3529entries.
3530
3531@kindex --dsbt-index
3532@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3533This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3534to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3535executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3536@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3537
fbd9ad90
PB
3538@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3539The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3540exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3541
ac145307
BS
3542@end table
3543
3544@c man end
3545@end ifset
3546
b8891f8d
AJ
3547@ifset CSKY
3548@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3549
3550@c man begin OPTIONS
3551
3552@table @gcctabopt
3553
3554@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3555@item --branch-stub
3556This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3557sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3558usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3559can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3560the compiler or assembler.
3561
3562@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3563@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3564This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3565It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3566be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3567stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3568sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3569@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3570linker should choose suitable defaults.
3571
3572@end table
3573
3574@c man end
3575@end ifset
3576
93fd0973
SC
3577@ifset M68HC11
3578@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3579
3580@c man begin OPTIONS
3581
3582The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3583memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3584
3585@table @gcctabopt
3586
3587@kindex --no-trampoline
3588@item --no-trampoline
3589This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3590is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3591instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3592
3593@kindex --bank-window
3594@item --bank-window @var{name}
3595This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3596the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3597The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3598paging and addresses within the memory window.
3599
3600@end table
3601
3602@c man end
3603@end ifset
3604
7fb9f789
NC
3605@ifset M68K
3606@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3607
3608@c man begin OPTIONS
3609
3610The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3611when linking for 68K targets.
3612
3613@table @gcctabopt
3614
3615@kindex --got
3616@item --got=@var{type}
3617This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3618@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3619@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3620Info entry for @file{ld}.
3621
3622@end table
3623
3624@c man end
3625@end ifset
3626
833794fc
MR
3627@ifset MIPS
3628@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3629
3630@c man begin OPTIONS
3631
3632The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3633generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3634linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3635
3636@table @gcctabopt
3637
3638@kindex --insn32
3639@item --insn32
3640@kindex --no-insn32
3641@itemx --no-insn32
3642These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3643generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3644or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
364532-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3646used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3647possible.
3648
8b10b0b3
MR
3649@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3650@item --ignore-branch-isa
3651@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3652@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3653These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3654transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3655accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3656is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3657instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3658equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3659calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3660a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3661an error.
3662
3734320d
MF
3663@kindex --compact-branches
3664@item --compact-branches
3665@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3666@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3667These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3668in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3669
833794fc
MR
3670@end table
3671
3672@c man end
3673@end ifset
3674
fa1477dc
SC
3675
3676@ifset PDP11
3677@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3678
3679@c man begin OPTIONS
3680
3681For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3682produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3683for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3684targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3685defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3686here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3687
3688@table @gcctabopt
3689
3690@kindex -N
3691@item -N
3692@kindex --omagic
3693@itemx --omagic
3694
3695Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3696indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3697shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3698writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3699the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3700programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3701from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3702
3703@kindex -n
3704@item -n
3705@kindex --nmagic
3706@itemx --nmagic
3707
3708Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3709indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3710be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3711file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3712byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3713a @emph{pure executable} format.
3714
3715@kindex -z
3716@item -z
3717@kindex --imagic
3718@itemx --imagic
3719
3720Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3721indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3722data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3723instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3724larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3725to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3726shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3727option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3728and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3729this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3730executable} format.
3731
3732@kindex --no-omagic
3733@item --no-omagic
3734
3735Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3736
3737@end table
3738
3739@c man end
3740@end ifset
3741
252b5132
RH
3742@ifset UsesEnvVars
3743@node Environment
3744@section Environment Variables
3745
0285c67d
NC
3746@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3747
560e09e9 3748You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3749@ifclear SingleFormat
3750@code{GNUTARGET},
3751@end ifclear
3752@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3753
36f63dca 3754@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3755@kindex GNUTARGET
3756@cindex default input format
3757@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3758use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3759of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3760@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3761of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3762attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3763this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3764there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3765object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3766BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3767in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3768@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3769
3770@kindex LDEMULATION
3771@cindex default emulation
3772@cindex emulation, default
3773@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3774@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3775behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3776available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3777the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3778variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3779linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3780
3781@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3782@cindex demangling, default
3783Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3784@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3785default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3786a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3787may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3788options.
3789
0285c67d
NC
3790@c man end
3791@end ifset
3792
252b5132
RH
3793@node Scripts
3794@chapter Linker Scripts
3795
3796@cindex scripts
3797@cindex linker scripts
3798@cindex command files
3799Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3800written in the linker command language.
3801
3802The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3803the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3804the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3805more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3806direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3807described below.
3808
3809The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3810yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3811linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3812to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3813such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3814
3815You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3816line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3817default linker script.
3818
3819You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3820to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3821Linker Scripts}.
3822
3823@menu
3824* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3825* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3826* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3827* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3828* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3829* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3830* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3831* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3832* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3833* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3834* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3835@end menu
3836
3837@node Basic Script Concepts
3838@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3839@cindex linker script concepts
3840We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3841describe the linker script language.
3842
3843The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3844file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3845@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3846The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3847purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3848among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3849section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3850in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3851
3852Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3853also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3854contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3855the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3856A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3857area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3858loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3859which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3860of debugging information.
3861
3862Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3863first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3864the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3865@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3866section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3867same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3868is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3869(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3870based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3871RAM address would be the VMA.
3872
3873You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3874program with the @samp{-h} option.
3875
3876Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3877@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3878has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3879information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3880will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3881static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3882referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3883
3884You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3885program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3886option.
3887
3888@node Script Format
3889@section Linker Script Format
3890@cindex linker script format
3891Linker scripts are text files.
3892
3893You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3894either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3895symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3896generally ignored.
3897
3898Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3899If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3900otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3901double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3902file name.
3903
3904You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3905@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3906to whitespace.
3907
3908@node Simple Example
3909@section Simple Linker Script Example
3910@cindex linker script example
3911@cindex example of linker script
3912Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3913
3914The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3915@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3916memory layout of the output file.
3917
3918The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3919describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3920code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3921@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3922Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3923your input files.
3924
3925For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
39260x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3927linker script which will do that:
3928@smallexample
3929SECTIONS
3930@{
3931 . = 0x10000;
3932 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3933 . = 0x8000000;
3934 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3935 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3936@}
3937@end smallexample
3938
3939You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3940followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3941descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3942
252b5132
RH
3943The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3944sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3945counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3946other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3947current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3948incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3949@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3950
3951The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3952required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3953after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3954which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3955wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3956means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3957
3958Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3959@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3960@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3961
3962The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3963the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3964at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3965output section, the value of the location counter will be
3966@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3967effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3968immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3969
3970The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3971alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3972example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3973sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3974may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3975sections.
3976
3977That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3978
3979@node Simple Commands
3980@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3981@cindex linker script simple commands
3982In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3983
3984@menu
3985* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3986* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3987@ifclear SingleFormat
3988* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3989@end ifclear
3990
4a93e180 3991* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3992* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3993@end menu
3994
3995@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3996@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3997@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3998@cindex start of execution
3999@cindex first instruction
4000@cindex entry point
4001The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4002point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4003entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4004@smallexample
4005ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4006@end smallexample
4007
4008There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4009entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4010stopping when one of them succeeds:
4011@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 4012@item
252b5132 4013the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 4014@item
252b5132 4015the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 4016@item
a094d01f 4017the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 4018targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 4019check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 4020@item
5226a6a8
NC
4021the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4022executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 4023@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 4024@item
252b5132
RH
4025The address @code{0}.
4026@end itemize
4027
4028@node File Commands
36f63dca 4029@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4030@cindex linker script file commands
4031Several linker script commands deal with files.
4032
4033@table @code
4034@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4035@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4036@cindex including a linker script
4037Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4038be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4039with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
404010 levels deep.
4041
4006703d
NS
4042You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4043@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4044
252b5132
RH
4045@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4046@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4047@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4048@cindex input files in linker scripts
4049@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4050@cindex linker script input object files
4051The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4052in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4053
4054For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4055a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4056then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4057
4058In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4059script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4060
e3f2db7f
AO
4061In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4062with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4063located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4064for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4065@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4066filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4067@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4068
4069If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4070the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4071found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4072not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4073path.
252b5132 4074
ff5dcc92 4075If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4076name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4077@samp{-l}.
4078
4079When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4080files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4081script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4082
4083@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4084@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4085@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4086@cindex grouping input files
4087The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4088files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4089new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4090in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4091
b717d30e
JJ
4092@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4093@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4094@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4095This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4096commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4097as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4098with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4099when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4100@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4101and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4102setting afterwards.
4103
252b5132
RH
4104@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4105@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4106@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4107The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4108@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4109@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4110Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4111precedence.
4112
4113You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4114output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4115
4116@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4117@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4118@cindex library search path in linker script
4119@cindex archive search path in linker script
4120@cindex search path in linker script
4121The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4122@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4123@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4124on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4125are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4126the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4127
4128@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4129@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4130@cindex first input file
4131The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4132that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4133though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4134when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4135first file.
4136@end table
4137
4138@ifclear SingleFormat
4139@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4140@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4141A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4142
4143@table @code
4144@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4145@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4146@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4147@cindex output file format in linker script
4148The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4149output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4150exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4151(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4152line option takes precedence.
4153
4154You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4155formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4156This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4157desired endianness.
4158
4159If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4160will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4161output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4162used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4163
4164For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4165command:
4166@smallexample
4167OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4168@end smallexample
4169This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4170@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4171option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4172format.
4173
4174@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4175@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4176@cindex input file format in linker script
4177The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4178files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4179This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4180(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4181is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4182command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4183@end table
4184@end ifclear
4185
4a93e180
NC
4186@node REGION_ALIAS
4187@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4188@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4189@cindex region alias
4190@cindex region names
4191
4192Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4193@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4194
4195@smallexample
4196REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4197@end smallexample
4198
4199The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4200memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4201to memory regions. An example follows.
4202
4203Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4204memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4205that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4206non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4207access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4208read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4209sections:
4210
4211@itemize @bullet
4212@item
4213@code{.text} program code;
4214@item
4215@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4216@item
4217@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4218@item
4219@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4220@end itemize
4221
4222The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4223part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4224output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4225systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4226@code{C}:
4227@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4228@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4229@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4230@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4231@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4232@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4233@end multitable
4234The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4235loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4236the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4237the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4238
4239The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4240includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4241memory layout:
4242@smallexample
4243INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4244
4245SECTIONS
4246 @{
4247 .text :
4248 @{
4249 *(.text)
4250 @} > REGION_TEXT
4251 .rodata :
4252 @{
4253 *(.rodata)
4254 rodata_end = .;
4255 @} > REGION_RODATA
4256 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4257 @{
4258 data_start = .;
4259 *(.data)
4260 @} > REGION_DATA
4261 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4262 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4263 .bss :
4264 @{
4265 *(.bss)
4266 @} > REGION_BSS
4267 @}
4268@end smallexample
4269
4270Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4271regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4272variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4273@table @code
4274@item A
4275Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4276@smallexample
4277MEMORY
4278 @{
4279 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4280 @}
4281
4282REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4283REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4284REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4285REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4286@end smallexample
4287@item B
4288Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4289into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4290@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4291@smallexample
4292MEMORY
4293 @{
4294 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4295 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4296 @}
4297
4298REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4299REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4300REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4301REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4302@end smallexample
4303@item C
4304Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4305@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4306initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4307system start into the @code{RAM}.
4308@smallexample
4309MEMORY
4310 @{
4311 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4312 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4313 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4314 @}
4315
4316REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4317REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4318REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4319REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4320@end smallexample
4321@end table
4322
4323It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4324@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4325necessary:
4326@smallexample
4327#include <string.h>
4328
4329extern char data_start [];
4330extern char data_size [];
4331extern char data_load_start [];
4332
4333void copy_data(void)
4334@{
4335 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4336 @{
4337 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4338 @}
4339@}
4340@end smallexample
4341
252b5132 4342@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4343@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4344There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4345
4346@table @code
4347@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4348@kindex ASSERT
4349@cindex assertion in linker script
4350Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4351with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4352
fd1c4238
NC
4353Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4354take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4355inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4356for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4357symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4358
4359@smallexample
4360 .stack :
4361 @{
4362 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4363 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4364 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4365 @}
4366@end smallexample
4367
4368will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4369PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4370can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4371
4372@smallexample
4373 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4374 .stack :
4375 @{
4376 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4377 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4378 @}
4379@end smallexample
4380
4381will work.
4382
252b5132
RH
4383@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4384@kindex EXTERN
4385@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4386Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4387symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4388modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4389each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4390command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4391
4392@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4393@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4394@cindex common allocation in linker script
4395This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4396to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4397output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4398
4818e05f
AM
4399@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4400@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4401@cindex common allocation in linker script
4402This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4403command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4404to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4405
7bdf4127
AB
4406@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4407@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4408@cindex group allocation in linker script
4409@cindex section groups
4410@cindex COMDAT
4411This command has the same effect as the
4412@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4413@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4414and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4415specified (@samp{-r}).
4416
53d25da6
AM
4417@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4418@kindex INSERT
4419@cindex insert user script into default script
4420This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4421augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4422inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4423@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4424default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4425sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4426linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4427insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4428linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4429default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4430of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4431to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4432is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4433
4434@smallexample
4435SECTIONS
4436@{
4437 OVERLAY :
4438 @{
4439 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4440 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4441 @}
4442@}
4443INSERT AFTER .text;
4444@end smallexample
4445
31f14901
AM
4446Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4447script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4448of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4449The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4450command line.
4451
252b5132
RH
4452@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4453@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4454@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4455This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4456references among certain output sections.
4457
4458In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4459using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4460will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4461errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4462a function defined in the other section.
4463
4464The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4465@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4466an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4467@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4468names.
4469
cdf96953
MF
4470@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4471@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4472@cindex cross references
4473This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4474references to one section from a list of other sections.
4475
4476The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4477output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4478a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4479there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4480must never call back.
4481
4482The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4483The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4484If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4485the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4486status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4487names, not input section names.
4488
252b5132
RH
4489@ifclear SingleFormat
4490@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4491@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4492@cindex machine architecture
4493@cindex architecture
4494Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4495of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4496architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4497the @samp{-f} option.
4498@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4499
4500@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4501@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4502This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4503@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4504in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4505@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4506@end table
4507
4508@node Assignments
4509@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4510@cindex assignment in scripts
4511@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4512@cindex variables, defining
4513You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4514the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4515
4516@menu
4517* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4518* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4519* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4520* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4521* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4522@end menu
4523
4524@node Simple Assignments
4525@subsection Simple Assignments
4526
4527You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4528
4529@table @code
4530@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4531@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4532@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4533@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4534@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4535@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4536@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4537@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4538@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4539@end table
4540
4541The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4542@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4543defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4544
4545The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4546may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4547
4548The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4549
4550Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4551
4552You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4553statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4554section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4555
4556The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4557expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4558
4559Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4560assignments may be used:
4561
4562@smallexample
4563floating_point = 0;
4564SECTIONS
4565@{
4566 .text :
4567 @{
4568 *(.text)
4569 _etext = .;
4570 @}
156e34dd 4571 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4572 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4573@}
4574@end smallexample
4575@noindent
4576In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4577zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4578the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4579defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4580upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4581
eb8476a6
MR
4582@node HIDDEN
4583@subsection HIDDEN
4584@cindex HIDDEN
4585For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4586exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4587
4588Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4589@code{HIDDEN}:
4590
4591@smallexample
4592HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4593SECTIONS
4594@{
4595 .text :
4596 @{
4597 *(.text)
4598 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4599 @}
4600 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4601 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4602@}
4603@end smallexample
4604@noindent
4605In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4606
252b5132
RH
4607@node PROVIDE
4608@subsection PROVIDE
4609@cindex PROVIDE
4610In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4611only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4612the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4613@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4614@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4615@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4616@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4617@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4618
4619Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4620@smallexample
4621SECTIONS
4622@{
4623 .text :
4624 @{
4625 *(.text)
4626 _etext = .;
4627 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4628 @}
4629@}
4630@end smallexample
4631
4632In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4633underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4634on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4635underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4636If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4637linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4638
b0daac83
NC
4639Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4640defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4641that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4642when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4643@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4644
7af8e998
L
4645@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4646@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4647@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4648Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4649hidden and won't be exported.
4650
73ae6183
NC
4651@node Source Code Reference
4652@subsection Source Code Reference
4653
4654Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4655intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4656a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4657symbol that does not have a value.
4658
4659Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4660transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4661stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4662prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4663mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4664of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4665variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4666linker script variable might be referred to as:
4667
4668@smallexample
4669 extern int foo;
4670@end smallexample
4671
4672But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4673
4674@smallexample
4675 _foo = 1000;
4676@end smallexample
4677
4678In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4679transformation has taken place.
4680
4681When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4682things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4683in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4684second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4685table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4686contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4687value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4688
4689@smallexample
4690 int foo = 1000;
4691@end smallexample
4692
10bf6894 4693creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4694holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4695number 1000 is initially stored.
4696
4697When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4698first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4699memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4700So:
4701
4702@smallexample
4703 foo = 1;
4704@end smallexample
4705
4706looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4707associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4708address. Whereas:
4709
4710@smallexample
4711 int * a = & foo;
4712@end smallexample
4713
10bf6894 4714looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4715and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4716the variable @samp{a}.
4717
4718Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4719the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4720an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4721
4722@smallexample
4723 foo = 1000;
4724@end smallexample
4725
4726creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4727the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4728address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4729linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4730access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4731
4732Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4733you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4734use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4735section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4736linker script contains these declarations:
4737
4738@smallexample
4739@group
4740 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4741 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4742 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4743@end group
4744@end smallexample
4745
4746Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4747
4748@smallexample
4749@group
4750 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4751
73ae6183
NC
4752 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4753@end group
4754@end smallexample
4755
4756Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4757Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4758arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4759
4760@smallexample
4761@group
4762 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4763
4764 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4765@end group
4766@end smallexample
4767
4768Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4769operators.
73ae6183 4770
252b5132 4771@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4772@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4773@kindex SECTIONS
4774The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4775into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4776
4777The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4778@smallexample
4779SECTIONS
4780@{
4781 @var{sections-command}
4782 @var{sections-command}
4783 @dots{}
4784@}
4785@end smallexample
4786
4787Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4788
4789@itemize @bullet
4790@item
4791an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4792@item
4793a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4794@item
4795an output section description
4796@item
4797an overlay description
4798@end itemize
4799
4800The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4801@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4802those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4803understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4804the layout of the output file.
4805
4806Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4807below.
4808
4809If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4810linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4811section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4812input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4813example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4814in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4815
4816@menu
4817* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4818* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4819* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4820* Input Section:: Input section description
4821* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4822* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4823* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4824* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4825* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4826@end menu
4827
4828@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4829@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4830The full description of an output section looks like this:
4831@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4832@group
7e7d5768 4833@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4834 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4835 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4836 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4837 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4838 @{
4839 @var{output-section-command}
4840 @var{output-section-command}
4841 @dots{}
abc9061b 4842 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4843@end group
4844@end smallexample
4845
4846Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4847
4848The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4849name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4850The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4851the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4852The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4853
4854Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4855
4856@itemize @bullet
4857@item
4858a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4859@item
4860an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4861@item
4862data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4863@item
4864a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4865@end itemize
4866
4867@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4868@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4869@cindex name, section
4870@cindex section name
4871The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4872meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4873support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4874must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4875example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4876output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4877names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4878quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4879characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4880commas must be quoted.
4881
4882The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4883Discarding}.
4884
4885@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4886@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4887@cindex address, section
4888@cindex section address
4889The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4890address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4891is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4892
4893If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4894section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4895to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4896alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4897contained within the output section.
4898
4899The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4900
4901@itemize @bullet
4902@item
4903If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4904is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4905in that region.
4906
4907@item
4908If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4909regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4910section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4911be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4912
4913@item
4914If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4915the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4916counter.
4917@end itemize
4918
4919@noindent
4920For example:
4921
252b5132
RH
4922@smallexample
4923.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4924@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4925
252b5132
RH
4926@noindent
4927and
ea5cae92 4928
252b5132
RH
4929@smallexample
4930.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4931@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4932
252b5132
RH
4933@noindent
4934are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4935@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4936counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4937counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4938input sections.
252b5132
RH
4939
4940The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4941For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4942so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4943do something like this:
4944@smallexample
4945.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4946@end smallexample
4947@noindent
4948This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4949aligned upward to the specified value.
4950
4951Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4952location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4953sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4954
4955@node Input Section
36f63dca 4956@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4957@cindex input sections
4958@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4959The most common output section command is an input section description.
4960
4961The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4962You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4963in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4964map the input files into your memory layout.
4965
4966@menu
4967* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4968* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4969* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4970* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4971* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4972@end menu
4973
4974@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4975@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4976@cindex input section basics
4977An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4978by a list of section names in parentheses.
4979
4980The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4981describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4982
4983The most common input section description is to include all input
4984sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4985include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4986@smallexample
4987*(.text)
4988@end smallexample
4989@noindent
18625d54 4990Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4991@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4992of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4993match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4994example:
252b5132 4995@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4996EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4997@end smallexample
4998@noindent
4999will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5000and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5001placed inside the section list, for example:
5002@smallexample
b4346c09 5003*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 5004@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5005@noindent
5006The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5007two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5008more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
5009
5010There are two ways to include more than one section:
5011@smallexample
5012*(.text .rdata)
5013*(.text) *(.rdata)
5014@end smallexample
5015@noindent
5016The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5017@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
5018first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5019they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
5020@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5021@samp{.rdata} input sections.
5022
8f1732fc
AB
5023When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5024is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5025immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5026@smallexample
5027*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5028@end smallexample
5029@noindent
5030will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5031@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5032from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5033exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 5034could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5035@smallexample
5036*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5037@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5038@noindent
5039Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5040before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5041all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5042@smallexample
5043EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5044@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5045
252b5132
RH
5046You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5047You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5048needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5049@smallexample
5050data.o(.data)
5051@end smallexample
5052
ae17ab41
CM
5053To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5054of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5055
5056Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5057
5058@smallexample
5059@group
5060SECTIONS @{
5061 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5062 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5063@}
5064@end group
5065@end smallexample
5066
5067In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5068input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5069@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5070@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5071whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5072
967928e9
AM
5073You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5074matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5075with no whitespace around the colon.
5076
5077@table @samp
5078@item archive:file
5079matches file within archive
5080@item archive:
5081matches the whole archive
5082@item :file
5083matches file but not one in an archive
5084@end table
5085
5086Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5087wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5088single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5089@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5090within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5091also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5092other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5093from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5094command.
5095
252b5132
RH
5096If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5097the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5098commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5099@smallexample
5100data.o
5101@end smallexample
5102
967928e9
AM
5103When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5104and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5105characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5106name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5107did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5108though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5109@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5110the archive search path.
5111
5112@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5113@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5114@cindex input section wildcards
5115@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5116@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5117@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5118In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5119name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5120
5121The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5122pattern for the file name.
5123
5124The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5125
5126@table @samp
5127@item *
5128matches any number of characters
5129@item ?
5130matches any single character
5131@item [@var{chars}]
5132matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5133character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5134@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5135@item \
5136quotes the following character
5137@end table
5138
252b5132
RH
5139File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5140specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5141does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5142
5143If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5144appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5145will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5146sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5147@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5148@smallexample
5149.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5150.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5151@end smallexample
5152
bcaa7b3e 5153@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5154Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5155in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5156this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5157pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5158@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5159into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5160
bcaa7b3e 5161@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5162@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5163@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5164alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5165alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5166needed.
bcaa7b3e 5167
02ecc8e9 5168@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5169@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5170@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5171numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5172section name before placing them in the output file. In
5173@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5174the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5175@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5176
bcaa7b3e
L
5177@cindex SORT
5178@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5179
5180When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5181can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5182
5183@enumerate
5184@item
5185@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5186It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5187sections have the same name.
5188@item
5189@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5190It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5191sections have the same alignment.
5192@item
c0065db7 5193@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5194treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5195@item
5196@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5197is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5198@item
5199All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5200@end enumerate
5201
a05a5b64 5202When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5203section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5204takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5205
5206If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5207command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5208treated as nested sorting command.
5209
5210@enumerate
5211@item
5212@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5213@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5214@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5215@item
5216@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5217@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5218@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5219@end enumerate
5220
5221If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5222command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5223
eda680f8 5224@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5225@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5226section sorting option.
5227
252b5132
RH
5228If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5229@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5230precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5231
5232This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5233files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5234sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5235The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5236with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5237linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5238@smallexample
5239@group
5240SECTIONS @{
5241 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5242 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5243 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5244 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5245@}
5246@end group
5247@end smallexample
5248
5249@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5250@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5251@cindex common symbol placement
5252@cindex uninitialized data placement
5253A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5254file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5255linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5256named @samp{COMMON}.
5257
5258You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5259other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5260particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5261input files are placed in another section.
5262
5263In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5264@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5265@smallexample
5266.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5267@end smallexample
5268
5269@cindex scommon section
5270@cindex small common symbols
5271Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5272example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5273symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5274different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5275the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5276symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5277to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5278locations.
5279
5280@cindex [COMMON]
5281You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5282notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5283@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5284
5285@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5286@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5287@cindex KEEP
5288@cindex garbage collection
5289When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5290it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5291This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5292with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5293@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5294
5295@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5296@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5297The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5298to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5299start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5300@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5301follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5302@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5303@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5304All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5305files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5306
5307@smallexample
5308@group
5309SECTIONS @{
5310 outputa 0x10000 :
5311 @{
5312 all.o
5313 foo.o (.input1)
5314 @}
36f63dca
NC
5315@end group
5316@group
252b5132
RH
5317 outputb :
5318 @{
5319 foo.o (.input2)
5320 foo1.o (.input1)
5321 @}
36f63dca
NC
5322@end group
5323@group
252b5132
RH
5324 outputc :
5325 @{
5326 *(.input1)
5327 *(.input2)
5328 @}
5329@}
5330@end group
a1ab1d2a 5331@end smallexample
252b5132 5332
cbd0eecf
L
5333If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5334and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5335automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5336__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5337indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5338respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5339C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
75bd292b 5340
252b5132 5341@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5342@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5343@cindex data
5344@cindex section data
5345@cindex output section data
a4d5aec7 5346@kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
252b5132
RH
5347@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5348@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5349@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5350@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5351@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5352You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5353@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5354an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5355parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5356value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5357counter.
5358
5359The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5360store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5361bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5362stored.
5363
5364For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5365of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5366@smallexample
5367BYTE(1)
5368LONG(addr)
5369@end smallexample
5370
5371When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5372same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5373target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5374@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5375@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5376
5377If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5378which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5379When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5380true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5381endianness of the first input object file.
5382
a4d5aec7
AM
5383You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5384@code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5385the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5386end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5387quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5388Hex numbers are not supported.
5389
5390For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5391@smallexample
5392 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5393@end smallexample
5394
36f63dca 5395Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5396between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5397@smallexample
5398SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5399@end smallexample
5400whereas this will work:
5401@smallexample
5402SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5403@end smallexample
75bd292b 5404
252b5132
RH
5405@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5406@cindex holes, filling
5407@cindex unspecified memory
5408You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5409current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5410otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5411gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5412with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5413necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5414point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5415than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5416different parts of an output section.
5417
5418This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5419value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5420@smallexample
563e308f 5421FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5422@end smallexample
5423
5424The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5425section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5426part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5427entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5428precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5429expression.
252b5132 5430
2d5783fa
NC
5431@kindex LINKER_VERSION
5432@cindex LINKER_VERSION
5433Inserts a string containing the version of the linker at the current
5434point. Note - by default this directive is disabled and will do
5435nothing. It only becomes active if the
5436@option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5437
5438Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5439directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5440
252b5132 5441@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5442@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5443There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5444commands.
5445
5446@table @code
5447@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5448@cindex input filename symbols
5449@cindex filename symbols
5450@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5451The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5452The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5453file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5454the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5455
5456This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5457normally used for any other object file format.
5458
5459@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5460@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5461@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5462@item CONSTRUCTORS
5463When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5464unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5465destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5466arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5467automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5468For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5469linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5470@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5471ignored for other object file formats.
5472
5473The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5474constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5475Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5476the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5477first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5478of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5479compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5480formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5481@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5482the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5483destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5484@code{exit}.
5485
5486For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5487arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5488addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5489and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5490linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5491runtime code expects to see.
5492
5493@smallexample
5494 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5495 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5496 *(.ctors)
5497 LONG(0)
5498 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5499 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5500 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5501 *(.dtors)
5502 LONG(0)
5503 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5504@end smallexample
5505
5506If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5507which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5508are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5509are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5510command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5511@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5512@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5513@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5514
5515Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5516and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5517need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5518scripts.
5519
5520@end table
5521
5522@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5523@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5524@cindex discarding sections
5525@cindex sections, discarding
5526@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5527The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5528This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5529may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5530@smallexample
49c13adb 5531.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5532@end smallexample
5533@noindent
5534will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5535@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5536sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5537space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5538too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5539space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5540@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5541@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5542This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5543
a0976ea4 5544The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5545on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5546symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5547the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5548section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5549
5550@cindex /DISCARD/
5551The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5552input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5553section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5554
99fabbc9
JL
5555This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5556@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5557garbage collection.
5558
a2e098c3
NC
5559Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5560discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5561members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5562Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5563
252b5132 5564@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5565@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5566@cindex output section attributes
5567We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5568like this:
0c71d759 5569
252b5132 5570@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5571@group
7e7d5768 5572@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5573 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5574 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5575 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5576 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5577 @{
5578 @var{output-section-command}
5579 @var{output-section-command}
5580 @dots{}
562d3460 5581 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5582@end group
5583@end smallexample
0c71d759 5584
252b5132
RH
5585We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5586@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5587remaining section attributes.
5588
a1ab1d2a 5589@menu
252b5132
RH
5590* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5591* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5592* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5593* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5594* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5595* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5596* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5597* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5598@end menu
5599
5600@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5601@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5602Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5603parentheses. The following types are defined:
5604
5605@table @code
dcb53d93 5606
252b5132
RH
5607@item NOLOAD
5608The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5609loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5610
6b86da53
LB
5611@item READONLY
5612The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5613
252b5132 5614@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5615@item COPY
5616@item INFO
5617@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5618These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5619rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5620marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5621section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5622
c212f39d
FS
5623@item TYPE = @var{type}
5624Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5625output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5626@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5627@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5628for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5629special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5630
5631Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5632section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5633@smallexample
5634 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5635@end smallexample
5636will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5637@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5638type. Whereas:
5639@smallexample
5640 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5641@end smallexample
5642will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5643to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5644type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5645@smallexample
5646 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5647@end smallexample
5648
c212f39d
FS
5649@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5650This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5651type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5652
252b5132
RH
5653@end table
5654
5655@kindex NOLOAD
5656@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5657@cindex loading, preventing
5658The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5659the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5660the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5661@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5662need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5663@smallexample
5664@group
5665SECTIONS @{
5666 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5667 @dots{}
5668@}
5669@end group
5670@end smallexample
5671
5672@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5673@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5674@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5675@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5676@cindex load address
5677@cindex section load address
5678Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5679@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5680@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5681specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5682address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5683
ea5cae92
NC
5684The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5685specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5686takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5687load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5688region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5689
5690If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5691section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5692load address:
5693
5694@itemize @bullet
5695@item
5696If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5697the LMA address as well.
5698
5699@item
5700If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5701
5702@item
5703Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5704with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5705section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5706VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5707the last section in the located region.
5708
5709@item
5710If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5711that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5712
5713@item
5714If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5715section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5716@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5717
5718@cindex ROM initialized data
5719@cindex initialized data in ROM
5720This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5721example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5722called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5723@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5724even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5725uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5726defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5727counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5728
5729@smallexample
5730@group
5731SECTIONS
5732 @{
5733 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5734 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5735 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5736 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5737 .bss 0x3000 :
5738 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5739@}
5740@end group
5741@end smallexample
5742
5743The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5744this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5745the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5746how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5747script.
5748
5749@smallexample
5750@group
5751extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5752char *src = &_etext;
5753char *dst = &_data;
5754
ea5cae92
NC
5755/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5756while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5757 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5758
ea5cae92 5759/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5760for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5761 *dst = 0;
5762@end group
5763@end smallexample
5764
bbf115d3
L
5765@node Forced Output Alignment
5766@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5767@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5768@cindex forcing output section alignment
5769@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5770You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5771alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5772intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5773
7e7d5768
AM
5774@node Forced Input Alignment
5775@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5776@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5777@cindex forcing input section alignment
5778@cindex input section alignment
5779You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5780SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5781sections, whether larger or smaller.
5782
0c71d759
NC
5783@node Output Section Constraint
5784@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5785@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5786@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5787@cindex constraints on output sections
5788You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5789of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5790read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5791@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5792
252b5132 5793@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5794@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5795@kindex >@var{region}
5796@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5797@cindex memory regions and sections
5798You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5799using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5800
5801Here is a simple example:
5802@smallexample
5803@group
5804MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5805SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5806@end group
5807@end smallexample
5808
5809@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5810@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5811@kindex :@var{phdr}
5812@cindex section, assigning to program header
5813@cindex program headers and sections
5814You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5815using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5816one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5817assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5818@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5819linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5820
5821Here is a simple example:
5822@smallexample
5823@group
5824PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5825SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5826@end group
5827@end smallexample
5828
5829@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5830@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5831@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5832@cindex section fill pattern
5833@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5834You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5835@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5836(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5837within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5838alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5839necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5840of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5841an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5842fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5843other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5844pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5845expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5846
5847You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5848output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5849
5850Here is a simple example:
5851@smallexample
5852@group
563e308f 5853SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5854@end group
5855@end smallexample
5856
5857@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5858@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5859@kindex OVERLAY
5860@cindex overlays
5861An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5862are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5863the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5864copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5865required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5866can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5867than another.
5868
5869Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5870@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5871output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5872command is as follows:
5873@smallexample
5874@group
5875OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5876 @{
5877 @var{secname1}
5878 @{
5879 @var{output-section-command}
5880 @var{output-section-command}
5881 @dots{}
5882 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5883 @var{secname2}
5884 @{
5885 @var{output-section-command}
5886 @var{output-section-command}
5887 @dots{}
5888 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5889 @dots{}
abc9061b 5890 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5891@end group
5892@end smallexample
5893
5894Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5895section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5896section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5897those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5898except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5899sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5900
abc9061b
CC
5901The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5902the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5903
252b5132
RH
5904The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5905addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5906memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5907whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5908and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5909and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5910
56dd11f0
NC
5911If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5912references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5913the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5914sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5915@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5916
5917For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5918provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5919defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5920@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5921the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5922within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5923symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5924
5925At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5926the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5927
5928Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5929@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5930@smallexample
5931@group
5932 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5933 @{
5934 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5935 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5936 @}
5937@end group
5938@end smallexample
5939@noindent
5940This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5941address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5942@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5943following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5944@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5945@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5946
5947C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5948like the following.
5949
5950@smallexample
5951@group
5952 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5953 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5954 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5955@end group
5956@end smallexample
5957
5958Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5959everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5960example could have been written identically as follows.
5961
5962@smallexample
5963@group
5964 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5965 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5966 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5967 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5968 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5969 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5970 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5971@end group
5972@end smallexample
5973
5974@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5975@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5976@kindex MEMORY
5977@cindex memory regions
5978@cindex regions of memory
5979@cindex allocating memory
5980@cindex discontinuous memory
5981The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5982memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5983
5984The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5985memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5986may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5987can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5988set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5989regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5990around to fit into the available regions.
5991
127fcdff
AB
5992A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5993however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5994specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5995@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5996@smallexample
5997@group
a1ab1d2a 5998MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5999 @{
6000 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6001 @dots{}
6002 @}
6003@end group
6004@end smallexample
6005
6006The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6007region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6008Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6009with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
6010must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6011add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 6012command.
252b5132
RH
6013
6014@cindex memory region attributes
6015The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6016whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6017not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6018@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6019section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6020the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6021them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6022
6023The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6024@table @samp
6025@item R
6026Read-only section
6027@item W
6028Read/write section
6029@item X
6030Executable section
6031@item A
6032Allocatable section
6033@item I
6034Initialized section
6035@item L
6036Same as @samp{I}
6037@item !
c09e9a8c 6038Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
6039@end table
6040
81c688d5 6041If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 6042@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
6043attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6044unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6045not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6046string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6047or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6048the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
6049
6050@kindex ORIGIN =
6051@kindex o =
6052@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
6053The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6054the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6055cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6056abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6057@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6058
6059@kindex LENGTH =
6060@kindex len =
6061@kindex l =
6062The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6063region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6064be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6065@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6066
6067In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6068available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6069and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6070linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6071is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6072or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6073explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6074region.
6075
6076@smallexample
6077@group
a1ab1d2a 6078MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6079 @{
6080 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6081 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6082 @}
6083@end group
6084@end smallexample
6085
6086Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6087specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6088@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6089a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6090output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6091was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6092the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6093output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6094region, the linker will issue an error message.
6095
3ec57632 6096It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6097expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6098@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6099
6100@smallexample
6101@group
c0065db7 6102 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6103@end group
6104@end smallexample
6105
252b5132
RH
6106@node PHDRS
6107@section PHDRS Command
6108@kindex PHDRS
6109@cindex program headers
6110@cindex ELF program headers
6111@cindex program segments
6112@cindex segments, ELF
6113The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6114@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6115loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6116program with the @samp{-p} option.
6117
6118When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6119reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6120program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6121This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6122interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6123
6124The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6125in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6126precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6127the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6128not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6129
6130The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6131generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6132ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6133
6134This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6135@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6136
6137@smallexample
6138@group
6139PHDRS
6140@{
6141 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6142 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6143@}
6144@end group
6145@end smallexample
6146
6147The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6148of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6149header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6150with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6151must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6152is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6153
6154Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6155system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6156specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6157sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6158attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6159Section Phdr}.
6160
6161It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6162merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6163repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6164contain the section.
6165
6166If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6167then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6168not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6169convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6170placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6171default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6172segment at all.
6173
6174@kindex FILEHDR
6175@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6176You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6177the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6178The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6179file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6180include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6181segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6182these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6183
6184The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6185value of the keyword.
6186
6187@table @asis
6188@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6189Indicates an unused program header.
6190
6191@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6192Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6193the file.
6194
6195@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6196Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6197
6198@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6199Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6200found.
6201
6202@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6203Indicates a segment holding note information.
6204
6205@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6206A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6207ABI.
6208
6209@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6210Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6211
1a9ccd70
NC
6212@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6213Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6214
252b5132
RH
6215@item @var{expression}
6216An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6217be used for types not defined above.
6218@end table
6219
6220You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6221in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6222@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6223Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6224output section attribute.
6225
6226The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6227which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6228explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6229an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6230header.
6231
6232Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6233headers used on a native ELF system.
6234
6235@example
6236@group
6237PHDRS
6238@{
6239 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6240 interp PT_INTERP ;
6241 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6242 data PT_LOAD ;
6243 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6244@}
6245
6246SECTIONS
6247@{
6248 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6249 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6250 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6251 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6252 @dots{}
6253 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6254 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6255 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6256 @dots{}
6257@}
6258@end group
6259@end example
6260
6261@node VERSION
6262@section VERSION Command
6263@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6264@cindex symbol versions
6265@cindex version script
6266@cindex versions of symbols
6267The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6268only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6269symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6270a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6271shared library.
6272
6273You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6274you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6275also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6276
6277The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6278@smallexample
6279VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6280@end smallexample
6281
6282The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6283Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6284version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6285version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6286version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6287scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6288library.
6289
6290The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6291examples.
6292
6293@smallexample
6294VERS_1.1 @{
6295 global:
6296 foo1;
6297 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6298 old*;
6299 original*;
6300 new*;
252b5132
RH
6301@};
6302
6303VERS_1.2 @{
6304 foo2;
6305@} VERS_1.1;
6306
6307VERS_2.0 @{
6308 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6309 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6310 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6311 "f(int, double)";
6312 @};
252b5132
RH
6313@} VERS_1.2;
6314@end smallexample
6315
6316This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6317version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6318The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6319a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6320of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6321symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6322is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6323in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6324However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6325name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6326
6327Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6328depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6329to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6330
6331Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6332depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6333and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6334
6335When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6336specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6337unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6338unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6339somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6340wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6341wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6342set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6343ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6344
6345The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6346they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6347could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6348However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6349
0f6bf451 6350Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6351in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6352symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6353won't.
6354
6355@smallexample
7c9c73be 6356@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6357@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6358
252b5132
RH
6359When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6360symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6361requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6362shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6363loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6364linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6365application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6366way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6367all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6368search for each symbol reference.
6369
6370The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6371doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6372that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6373functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6374the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6375required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6376that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6377versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6378the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6379
6380There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6381first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6382source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6383script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6384maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6385@smallexample
6386__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6387@end smallexample
6388@noindent
6389in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6390be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6391The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6392@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6393takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6394
6395The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6396function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6397an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6398version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6399linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6400
6401To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6402source file. Here is an example:
6403
6404@smallexample
6405__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6406__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6407__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6408__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6409@end smallexample
6410
6411In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6412unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6413example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6414@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6415
6416When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6417some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6418this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6419@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6420declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6421you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6422
6423If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6424within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6425(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6426specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6427
cb840a31
L
6428You can also specify the language in the version script:
6429
6430@smallexample
6431VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6432@end smallexample
6433
c0065db7 6434The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6435The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6436demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6437patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6438@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6439
86043bbb
MM
6440Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6441described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6442or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6443the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6444whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6445cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6446might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6447should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6448expect when you upgrade.
6449
252b5132
RH
6450@node Expressions
6451@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6452@cindex expressions
6453@cindex arithmetic
6454The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6455that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6456places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6457evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6458size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6459otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6460
6461You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6462
6463The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6464expressions.
6465
6466@menu
6467* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6468* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6469* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6470* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6471* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6472* Operators:: Operators
6473* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6474* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6475* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6476@end menu
6477
6478@node Constants
6479@subsection Constants
6480@cindex integer notation
6481@cindex constants in linker scripts
6482All constants are integers.
6483
6484As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6485octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6486hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6487@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6488@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6489value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6490
6491@cindex scaled integers
6492@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6493@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6494@cindex suffixes for integers
6495@cindex integer suffixes
6496In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6497constant by
6498@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6499@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6500@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6501@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6502@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6503@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6504@tex
6505${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6506@end tex
6507@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6508respectively. For example, the following
6509all refer to the same quantity:
6510
252b5132 6511@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6512_fourk_1 = 4K;
6513_fourk_2 = 4096;
6514_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6515_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6516@end smallexample
6517
8a308ae8
NC
6518Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6519conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6520
0c71d759
NC
6521@node Symbolic Constants
6522@subsection Symbolic Constants
6523@cindex symbolic constants
6524@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6525It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6526the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6527
6528@table @code
6529@item MAXPAGESIZE
6530@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6531The target's maximum page size.
6532
6533@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6534@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6535The target's default page size.
6536@end table
6537
6538So for example:
6539
6540@smallexample
9d5777a3 6541 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6542@end smallexample
6543
6544will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6545supported by the target.
6546
252b5132
RH
6547@node Symbols
6548@subsection Symbol Names
6549@cindex symbol names
6550@cindex names
6551@cindex quoted symbol names
6552@kindex "
6553Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6554and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6555Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6556specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6557keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6558@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6559"SECTION" = 9;
6560"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6561@end smallexample
6562
6563Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6564to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6565whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6566
ecca9871
L
6567@node Orphan Sections
6568@subsection Orphan Sections
6569@cindex orphan
6570Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6571are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6572script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6573output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6574in which to place the orphaned input section.
6575
6576If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6577an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6578placed at the end of that output section.
6579
6580If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6581sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6582name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6583orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6584one new output section.
6585
6586If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6587then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6588in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6589linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6590attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6591sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6592support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6593
a05a5b64
TP
6594The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6595(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6596output sections an orphan is placed in.
6597
252b5132
RH
6598@node Location Counter
6599@subsection The Location Counter
6600@kindex .
6601@cindex dot
6602@cindex location counter
6603@cindex current output location
6604The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6605current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6606location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6607within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6608anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6609
6610@cindex holes
6611Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6612moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6613location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6614and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6615doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6616
6617@smallexample
6618SECTIONS
6619@{
6620 output :
6621 @{
6622 file1(.text)
6623 . = . + 1000;
6624 file2(.text)
6625 . += 1000;
6626 file3(.text)
563e308f 6627 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6628@}
6629@end smallexample
6630@noindent
6631In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6632located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6633followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6634@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6635@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6636specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6637
5c6bbab8
NC
6638@cindex dot inside sections
6639Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6640current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6641statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6642absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6643however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6644not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6645
6646@smallexample
6647SECTIONS
6648@{
6649 . = 0x100
6650 .text: @{
6651 *(.text)
6652 . = 0x200
6653 @}
6654 . = 0x500
6655 .data: @{
6656 *(.data)
6657 . += 0x600
6658 @}
6659@}
6660@end smallexample
6661
6662The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6663and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6664the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6665much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6666move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6667and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6668the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6669the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6670
b5666f2f
AM
6671@cindex dot outside sections
6672Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6673output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6674needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6675
6676@smallexample
6677SECTIONS
6678@{
6679 start_of_text = . ;
6680 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6681 end_of_text = . ;
6682
6683 start_of_data = . ;
6684 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6685 end_of_data = . ;
6686@}
6687@end smallexample
6688
6689If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6690not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6691between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6692should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6693blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6694the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6695sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6696statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6697special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6698place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6699as follows:
6700
6701@smallexample
6702SECTIONS
6703@{
6704 start_of_text = . ;
6705 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6706 end_of_text = . ;
6707
6708 start_of_data = . ;
6709 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6710 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6711 end_of_data = . ;
6712@}
6713@end smallexample
6714
6715This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6716@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6717placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6718assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6719a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6720section. So you could write:
6721
6722@smallexample
6723SECTIONS
6724@{
6725 start_of_text = . ;
6726 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6727 end_of_text = . ;
6728
6729 . = . ;
6730 start_of_data = . ;
6731 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6732 end_of_data = . ;
6733@}
6734@end smallexample
6735
6736Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6737@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6738
252b5132
RH
6739@need 2000
6740@node Operators
6741@subsection Operators
6742@cindex operators for arithmetic
6743@cindex arithmetic operators
6744@cindex precedence in expressions
6745The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6746the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6747@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6748@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6749@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6750@smallexample
6751precedence associativity Operators Notes
6752(highest)
67531 left ! - ~ (1)
67542 left * / %
67553 left + -
67564 left >> <<
67575 left == != > < <= >=
67586 left &
67597 left |
67608 left &&
67619 left ||
676210 right ? :
676311 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6764(lowest)
6765@end smallexample
6766Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6767(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6768(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6769@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6770@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6771@tex
6772\vskip \baselineskip
6773%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6774\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6775\hrule
6776\halign
6777{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6778height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6779&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6780height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6781\noalign{\hrule}
6782height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6783&highest&&&&&\cr
6784% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6785&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6786&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6787&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6788&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6789&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6790&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6791&7&&left&&|&\cr
6792&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6793&9&&left&&||&\cr
6794&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6795&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6796&lowest&&&&&\cr
6797height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6798\hrule}
6799@end tex
6800@iftex
6801{
6802@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6803@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6804@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6805}
6806@end iftex
6807@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6808
6809@node Evaluation
6810@subsection Evaluation
6811@cindex lazy evaluation
6812@cindex expression evaluation order
6813The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6814an expression when absolutely necessary.
6815
6816The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6817address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6818regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6819as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6820
6821However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6822until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6823other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6824for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6825
6826The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6827assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6828allocation.
6829
6830Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6831@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6832
6833If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6834available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6835following
6836@smallexample
6837@group
6838SECTIONS
6839 @{
a1ab1d2a 6840 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6841 @{ *(.text) @}
6842 @}
6843@end group
6844@end smallexample
6845@noindent
6846will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6847address}.
6848
6849@node Expression Section
6850@subsection The Section of an Expression
6851@cindex expression sections
6852@cindex absolute expressions
6853@cindex relative expressions
6854@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6855@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6856@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6857Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6858relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6859using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6860value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6861symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6862operations.
6863
abf4be64
AM
6864Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6865section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6866address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6867@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6868functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6869One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6870(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6871differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6872versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6873section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6874Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6875absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6876given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6877everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6878
6879In the following simple example,
252b5132 6880
7542af2a
AM
6881@smallexample
6882@group
6883SECTIONS
6884 @{
6885 . = 0x100;
6886 __executable_start = 0x100;
6887 .data :
6888 @{
6889 . = 0x10;
6890 __data_start = 0x10;
6891 *(.data)
6892 @}
6893 @dots{}
6894 @}
6895@end group
6896@end smallexample
252b5132 6897
7542af2a
AM
6898both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6899address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6900@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6901section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6902
5c3049d2
AM
6903For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6904addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6905
6906@itemize @bullet
6907@item
c05f749e
AM
6908Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6909operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6910absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6911@item
7542af2a
AM
6912Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6913relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6914and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6915@item
c05f749e
AM
6916Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6917in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6918address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6919before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6920@end itemize
6921
6922The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6923
6924@itemize @bullet
6925@item
6926An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6927@item
6928The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6929@item
9bc8bb33 6930The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6931relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6932(after above conversions) is also a number when
6933@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6934but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6935@item
6936The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6937relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6938section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6939@item
6940The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6941conversions) is an absolute address.
6942@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6943
6944You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6945to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6946create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6947section @samp{.data}:
6948@smallexample
6949SECTIONS
6950 @{
6951 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6952 @}
6953@end smallexample
6954@noindent
6955If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6956@samp{.data} section.
6957
7542af2a
AM
6958Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6959particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6960
252b5132
RH
6961@node Builtin Functions
6962@subsection Builtin Functions
6963@cindex functions in expressions
6964The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6965use in linker script expressions.
6966
6967@table @code
6968@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6969@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6970@cindex expression, absolute
6971Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6972of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6973value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6974normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6975
6976@item ADDR(@var{section})
6977@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6978@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6979Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6980script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6981the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6982@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6983@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6984the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6985@smallexample
6986@group
6987SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6988 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6989 @{
252b5132
RH
6990 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6991 @dots{}
6992 @}
6993 .output :
6994 @{
6995 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6996 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6997 @}
6998@dots{} @}
6999@end group
7000@end smallexample
7001
876f4090
NS
7002@item ALIGN(@var{align})
7003@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7004@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7005@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
7006@cindex round up location counter
7007@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
7008@cindex round up expression
7009@cindex align expression
7010Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7011to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7012doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7013arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7014expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 7015equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
7016
7017Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7018next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7019variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7020input sections:
252b5132
RH
7021@smallexample
7022@group
7023SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7024 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7025 *(.data)
7026 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7027 @}
7028@dots{} @}
7029@end group
7030@end smallexample
7031@noindent
7032The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7033a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7034a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7035of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7036
7037The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7038
362c1d1a
NS
7039@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7040@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7041@cindex section alignment
7042Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7043been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7044evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7045the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
7046value in that section.
7047@smallexample
7048@group
7049SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7050 .output @{
7051 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7052 @dots{}
7053 @}
7054@dots{} @}
7055@end group
7056@end smallexample
7057
252b5132
RH
7058@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7059@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7060This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7061scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7062section.
7063
2d20f7bf
JJ
7064@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7065@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7066This is equivalent to either
7067@smallexample
7068(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7069@end smallexample
7070or
7071@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7072(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7073 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7074@end smallexample
7075@noindent
7076depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7077for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7078@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7079If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7080memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7081bytes in the on-disk file.
7082
7083This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7084any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7085@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7086be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7087running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7088that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7089page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7090
7091@noindent
7092Example:
7093@smallexample
7094 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7095@end smallexample
7096
7097@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7098@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7099This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7100evaluation purposes.
7101
7102@smallexample
7103 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7104@end smallexample
7105
a4f5ad88
JJ
7106@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7107@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7108This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7109@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7110When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7111does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7112@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7113argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7114script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7115@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7116padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7117section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7118
7119@smallexample
7120 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7121@end smallexample
7122
252b5132
RH
7123@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7124@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7125@cindex symbol defaults
7126Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7127defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7128return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7129default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7130shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7131the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7132existed, its value is preserved:
7133
7134@smallexample
7135@group
7136SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7137 .text : @{
7138 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7139 @dots{}
7140 @}
7141 @dots{}
7142@}
7143@end group
7144@end smallexample
7145
3ec57632
NC
7146@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7147@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7148Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7149
252b5132
RH
7150@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7151@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7152@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7153Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7154Section LMA}).
7155
2e53f7d6
NC
7156@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7157@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7158Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7159@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7160
252b5132
RH
7161@kindex MAX
7162@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7163Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7164
7165@kindex MIN
7166@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7167Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7168
7169@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7170@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7171@cindex unallocated address, next
7172Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7173This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7174use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7175output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7176
3ec57632
NC
7177@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7178@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7179Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7180
ba916c8a
MM
7181@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7182@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7183Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7184value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7185@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7186will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7187can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7188``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7189name.
7190
252b5132
RH
7191@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7192@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7193@cindex section size
7194Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7195been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7196evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7197@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7198@smallexample
7199@group
7200SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7201 .output @{
7202 .start = . ;
7203 @dots{}
7204 .end = . ;
7205 @}
7206 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7207 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7208@dots{} @}
7209@end group
7210@end smallexample
7211
7212@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7213@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7214@cindex header size
7215Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7216information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7217this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7218choose, to facilitate paging.
7219
7220@cindex not enough room for program headers
7221@cindex program headers, not enough room
7222When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7223@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7224number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7225addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7226additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7227room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7228the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7229script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7230you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7231command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7232@end table
7233
7234@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7235@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7236@cindex implicit linker scripts
7237If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7238an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7239linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7240linker will report an error.
7241
7242An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7243
7244Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7245assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7246commands.
7247
7248Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7249at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7250read. This can affect archive searching.
7251
bf6d8037
HC
7252@node Plugins
7253@chapter Linker Plugins
7254
7255@cindex plugins
7256@cindex linker plugins
7257The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7258For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7259support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7260
7261Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7262be added here later.
7263
9b38b85e 7264Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
3a117c58 7265command line option. @xref{Options}.
9b38b85e 7266
bf6d8037
HC
7267@menu
7268* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7269@end menu
7270
7271@node libdep Plugin
7272@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7273@cindex static library dependencies
7274Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7275just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7276optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7277within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7278rose to ascendance.
7279
7280One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7281multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7282dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7283library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7284referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7285link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7286libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7287explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7288
7289The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7290to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7291plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7292dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7293and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7294command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7295utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7296being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7297archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7298
7299For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7300library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7301the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7302
7303@smallexample
7304-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7305@end smallexample
7306
252b5132
RH
7307@ifset GENERIC
7308@node Machine Dependent
7309@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7310
7311@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7312@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7313sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7314functionality are not listed.
7315
7316@menu
36f63dca
NC
7317@ifset H8300
7318* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7319@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7320@ifset M68HC11
7321* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7322@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7323@ifset ARM
7324* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7325@end ifset
7326@ifset HPPA
7327* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7328@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7329@ifset M68K
7330* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7331@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7332@ifset MIPS
7333* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7334@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7335@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7336* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7337@end ifset
2469cfa2 7338@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7339* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7340@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7341@ifset NDS32
7342* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7343@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7344@ifset NIOSII
7345* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7346@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7347@ifset POWERPC
7348* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7349@end ifset
7350@ifset POWERPC64
7351* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7352@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7353@ifset S/390
7354* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7355@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7356@ifset SPU
7357* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7358@end ifset
74459f0e 7359@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7360* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7361@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7362@ifset WIN32
7363* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7364@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7365@ifset XTENSA
7366* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7367@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7368@end menu
7369@end ifset
7370
252b5132
RH
7371@ifset H8300
7372@ifclear GENERIC
7373@raisesections
7374@end ifclear
7375
7376@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7377@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7378
7379@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7380For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7381you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7382
7383@table @emph
7384@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7385@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7386@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7387targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7388program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7389respectively.
7390
7391@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7392@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7393@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7394@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7395sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7396page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7397(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7398@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7399top page of memory).
1502569c 7400
81f5558e
NC
7401@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7402indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7403displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7404the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7405@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7406whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7407range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7408
1502569c 7409@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7410@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7411biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7412which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7413page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7414(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7415@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7416the top page of memory).
7417
7418@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7419@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
742032 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7421changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7422(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7423@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7424the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7425@end table
7426
7427@ifclear GENERIC
7428@lowersections
7429@end ifclear
7430@end ifset
7431
36f63dca 7432@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7433@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7434@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7435@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7436@node Renesas
7437@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7438
c2dcd04e
NC
7439@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7440H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7441options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7442@end ifset
7443@end ifclear
7444
36f63dca
NC
7445@ifset ARM
7446@ifclear GENERIC
7447@raisesections
7448@end ifclear
7449
93fd0973
SC
7450@ifset M68HC11
7451@ifclear GENERIC
7452@raisesections
7453@end ifclear
7454
7455@node M68HC11/68HC12
7456@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7457
7458@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7459
7460@subsection Linker Relaxation
7461
7462For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7463optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7464
7465@table @emph
7466@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7467@item relaxing address modes
7468@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7469targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7470program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7471respectively.
7472
7473@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7474transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7475page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7476
7477@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7478When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7479of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7480addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7481@code{bset} instructions.
7482
7483@end table
7484
7485@subsection Trampoline Generation
7486
7487@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7488@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7489For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7490call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7491will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7492trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7493case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7494point to the function trampoline.
7495
7496@ifclear GENERIC
7497@lowersections
7498@end ifclear
7499@end ifset
7500
36f63dca 7501@node ARM
3674e28a 7502@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7503
7504@cindex ARM interworking support
7505@kindex --support-old-code
7506For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7507between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7508been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7509line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7510libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7511option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7512given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7513which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7514the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7515non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7516
7517@cindex thumb entry point
7518@cindex entry point, thumb
7519@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7520The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7521@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7522But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7523branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7524executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7525
ce11ba6c
KT
7526@cindex PE import table prefixing
7527@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7528The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7529the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7530element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7531import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7532
e489d0ae
PB
7533@cindex BE8
7534@kindex --be8
7535The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7536executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7537objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7538option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7539little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7540
3674e28a
PB
7541@cindex TARGET1
7542@kindex --target1-rel
7543@kindex --target1-abs
7544The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7545@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7546or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7547and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7548
7549@cindex TARGET2
7550@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7551The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7552@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7553meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7554@table @samp
7555@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7556@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7557@item abs
a57d1773 7558@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7559@item got-rel
7560@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7561@end table
7562
319850b4
JB
7563@cindex FIX_V4BX
7564@kindex --fix-v4bx
7565The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7566specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7567interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7568also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7569
7570In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7571linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7572@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7573
7574In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7575relocations are ignored.
7576
845b51d6
PB
7577@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7578@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7579Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7580relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7581
7582@smallexample
7583TST rM, #1
7584MOVEQ PC, rM
7585BX Rn
7586@end smallexample
7587
7588This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7589and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7590condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7591
33bfe774
JB
7592@cindex USE_BLX
7593@kindex --use-blx
7594The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7595BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7596situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7597code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7598each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7599
c6dd86c6
JB
7600@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7601@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7602The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7603bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7604instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7605to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7606the support code can read the intended values.
7607
7608The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7609intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7610and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7611intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7612full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7613you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7614
7615If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7616enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7617@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7618mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7619vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7620@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7621
7622If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7623potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7624such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7625first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7626instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7627the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7628are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7629
2de70689
MGD
7630@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7631@kindex --fix-arm1176
7632@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7633The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7634in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7635are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7636unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7637
9d5777a3 7638Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7639Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7640http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7641
a504d23a
LA
7642@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7643@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7644
7645The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7646workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7647the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7648off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7649the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7650core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7651integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7652VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7653
7654The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7655necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7656
7657The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7658@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7659STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7660linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7661@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7662
7663If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7664potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7665such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7666replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7667branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7668then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7669
7670The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7671the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7672
7673The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7674they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7675there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7676occurs.
7677
7678The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7679PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7680large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7681cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7682occurs.
7683
bf21ed78
MS
7684@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7685@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7686The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7687warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7688enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7689linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7690using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7691not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7692
7693@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7694@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7695The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7696warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7697@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7698linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7699using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7700
726150b7
NC
7701@cindex PIC_VENEER
7702@kindex --pic-veneer
7703The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7704ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7705is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7706@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7707
7708@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7709@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7710The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7711code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7712perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7713placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7714controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7715The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7716duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7717group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7718code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7719where they should be placed.
7720
7721The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7722@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7723placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7724branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7725placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7726value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7727exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7728A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7729linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7730from the input sections.
7731
7732The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7733@samp{N = +1}.
7734
1a51c1a4
NC
7735Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7736only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7737otherwise.
7738
1db37fe6
YG
7739@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7740@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7741@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7742The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7743
7744The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7745
68fcca92
JW
7746@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7747@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7748@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7749The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7750
7751Please contact ARM for further details.
7752
1db37fe6
YG
7753@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7754@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7755@cindex Merging exidx entries
7756The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7757
7758@kindex --long-plt
7759@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7760The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7761which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7762entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7763
1f56df9d
JW
7764@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7765@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7766The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7767link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7768
4ba2ef8f
TP
7769@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7770All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7771Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7772@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7773veneers in memory.
7774
54ddd295
TP
7775@kindex --cmse-implib
7776@cindex Secure gateway import library
7777The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7778specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7779secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7780executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7781
0955507f
TP
7782@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7783@cindex Input import library
7784The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7785must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7786given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7787in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7788@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7789library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7790library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7791for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7792specified.
7793
36f63dca
NC
7794@ifclear GENERIC
7795@lowersections
7796@end ifclear
7797@end ifset
7798
7799@ifset HPPA
7800@ifclear GENERIC
7801@raisesections
7802@end ifclear
7803
7804@node HPPA ELF32
7805@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7806@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7807@kindex --multi-subspace
7808When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7809import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7810The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7811stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7812multiple sub-spaces.
7813
7814@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7815@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7816Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7817stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7818@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7819sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7820a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7821the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7822conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7823prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7824A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7825branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7826@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7827@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7828detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7829positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7830
7831Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7832single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7833create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7834large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7835
7836@ifclear GENERIC
7837@lowersections
7838@end ifclear
7839@end ifset
7840
7fb9f789
NC
7841@ifset M68K
7842@ifclear GENERIC
7843@raisesections
7844@end ifclear
7845
7846@node M68K
7847@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7848
7849@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7850@kindex --got=@var{type}
7851The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7852The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7853@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7854the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7855@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7856entries only at non-negative offsets.
7857@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7858entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7859support such GOTs.
7860@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7861output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7862file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7863files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7864
7865@ifclear GENERIC
7866@lowersections
7867@end ifclear
7868@end ifset
7869
833794fc
MR
7870@ifset MIPS
7871@ifclear GENERIC
7872@raisesections
7873@end ifclear
7874
7875@node MIPS
7876@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7877
7878@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7879@kindex --insn32
7880@kindex --no-insn32
7881The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7882microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7883in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7884used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7885or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7886including 16-bit ones where possible.
7887
8b10b0b3
MR
7888@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7889@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7890@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7891The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7892control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7893@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7894relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7895calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7896relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7897instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7898or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7899the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7900
833794fc
MR
7901@ifclear GENERIC
7902@lowersections
7903@end ifclear
7904@end ifset
7905
36f63dca
NC
7906@ifset MMIX
7907@ifclear GENERIC
7908@raisesections
7909@end ifclear
7910
7911@node MMIX
7912@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7913For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7914@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7915understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7916can translate between the two formats.
7917
7918There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7919Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7920registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7921equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7922@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7923global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7924this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7925symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7926
7a2de473
HPN
7927Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7928@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7929The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7930of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7931
7932Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7933are left out from an mmo file.
7934
7935@ifclear GENERIC
7936@lowersections
7937@end ifclear
7938@end ifset
7939
7940@ifset MSP430
7941@ifclear GENERIC
7942@raisesections
7943@end ifclear
7944
7945@node MSP430
7946@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7947For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7948will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7949just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7950
7951@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7952The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7953
7954@table @code
7955@item @samp{.vectors}
7956Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7957
7958@item @samp{.bootloader}
7959Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7960in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7961
7962@item @samp{.infomem}
7963Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7964this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7965
c0065db7 7966@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7967This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7968in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7969
7970@item @samp{.noinit}
7971Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7972
c0065db7 7973The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7974@end table
7975
7ef3addb
JL
7976@table @option
7977@cindex MSP430 Options
7978@kindex --code-region
7979@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7980This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7981argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7982using this option.
7983
7984@kindex --data-region
7985@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7986This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7987[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7988for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7989
7990@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7991@item --disable-sec-transformation
7992Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7993and @code{--data-region} options.
7994This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7995wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7996not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7997@end table
7998
36f63dca
NC
7999@ifclear GENERIC
8000@lowersections
8001@end ifclear
8002@end ifset
8003
35c08157
KLC
8004@ifset NDS32
8005@ifclear GENERIC
8006@raisesections
8007@end ifclear
8008
8009@node NDS32
8010@section @code{ld} and NDS32
8011@kindex relaxing on NDS32
8012For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8013relaxes objects according to these options.
8014
8015@table @code
8016@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8017Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8018
8019@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8020Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8021
8022@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8023Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8024
8025@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8026Export the EX9 table after linking.
8027
8028@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8029Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8030
8031@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8032Update the existing EX9 table.
8033
8034@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8035Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8036
8037@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8038Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8039
8040@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8041Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8042
8043@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8044Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8045@end table
8046
8047@ifclear GENERIC
8048@lowersections
8049@end ifclear
8050@end ifset
8051
78058a5e
SL
8052@ifset NIOSII
8053@ifclear GENERIC
8054@raisesections
8055@end ifclear
8056
8057@node Nios II
8058@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8059@cindex Nios II call relaxation
8060@kindex --relax on Nios II
8061
8062Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8063transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8064which may result in @command{ld} giving
8065@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8066The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8067trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8068outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8069trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8070be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8071larger than 256MB.
8072
8073The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8074is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8075@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8076locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8077source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8078register as a temporary.
8079
8080Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8081relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8082option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8083
8084@ifclear GENERIC
8085@lowersections
8086@end ifclear
8087@end ifset
8088
2a60a7a8
AM
8089@ifset POWERPC
8090@ifclear GENERIC
8091@raisesections
8092@end ifclear
8093
8094@node PowerPC ELF32
8095@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8096@cindex PowerPC long branches
8097@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8098Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8099displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8100@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8101@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8102the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8103section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8104section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8105@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8106both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8107considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8108
8109@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8110@table @option
8111@cindex PowerPC PLT
8112@kindex --bss-plt
8113@item --bss-plt
8114Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8115generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8116the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8117writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8118@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8119PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8120compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8121BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8122
016687f8
AM
8123@kindex --secure-plt
8124@item --secure-plt
8125@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8126@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8127when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8128layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8129style BSS PLT.
8130
2a60a7a8
AM
8131@cindex PowerPC GOT
8132@kindex --sdata-got
8133@item --sdata-got
8134The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8135sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8136@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8137section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8138@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8139@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8140@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8141@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8142PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8143pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8144GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8145really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8146
8147@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8148@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8149@item --emit-stub-syms
8150This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8151symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8152
8153@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8154@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8155@item --no-tls-optimize
8156PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8157sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8158disable the optimization.
8159@end table
8160
8161@ifclear GENERIC
8162@lowersections
8163@end ifclear
8164@end ifset
8165
8166@ifset POWERPC64
8167@ifclear GENERIC
8168@raisesections
8169@end ifclear
8170
8171@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8172@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8173
8174@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8175@table @option
8176@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8177@kindex --stub-group-size
8178@item --stub-group-size
8179Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8180by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8181@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8182sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8183a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8184the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8185conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8186prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8187A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8188branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8189@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8190@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8191detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8192positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8193
8194Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8195single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8196create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8197large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8198
8199@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8200@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8201@item --emit-stub-syms
8202This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8203symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8204
8205@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8206@kindex --dotsyms
8207@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8208@item --dotsyms
8209@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8210These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8211in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8212function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8213code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8214properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8215to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8216@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8217dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8218feature.
8219
7ae4ea7d
AM
8220@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8221@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8222@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8223@item --save-restore-funcs
8224@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8225These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8226provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8227@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8228function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8229link.
8230
2a60a7a8
AM
8231@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8232@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8233@item --no-tls-optimize
8234PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8235sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8236disable the optimization.
8237
7c9cf415
AM
8238@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8239@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8240@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8241@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8242@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8243@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8244@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8245These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8246stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8247an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8248@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8249stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8250generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8251__tls_get_addr_opt.
8252Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8253much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8254an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8255will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8256@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8257and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8258this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8259Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8260@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8261register saves.
7c9cf415 8262
2a60a7a8
AM
8263@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8264@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8265@item --no-opd-optimize
8266PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8267corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8268the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8269Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8270
8271@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8272@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8273@item --non-overlapping-opd
8274Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8275@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8276the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8277entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8278
8279@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8280@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8281@item --no-toc-optimize
8282PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8283entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8284reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8285marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8286marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8287relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8288unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8289reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8290discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8291reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8292code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8293optimization.
8294
d882c988
AM
8295@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8296@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8297@item --no-inline-optimize
8298PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8299marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8300@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8301a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8302locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8303disables that optimization.
8304
2a60a7a8
AM
8305@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8306@kindex --no-multi-toc
8307@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8308If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8309@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8310where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8311entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8312total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8313grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8314TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8315calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8316help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
831764K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8318Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8319
8320@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8321@kindex --no-toc-sort
8322@item --no-toc-sort
8323By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8324happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8325placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8326with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8327referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8328@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8329results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8330off this feature.
8331
8332@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8333@kindex --plt-align
8334@kindex --no-plt-align
8335@item --plt-align
8336@itemx --no-plt-align
8337Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8338aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8339boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8340specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8341specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8342if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8343PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8344
8345@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8346@kindex --plt-static-chain
8347@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8348@item --plt-static-chain
8349@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8350Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8351chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8352chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8353
8354@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8355@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8356@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8357@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8358@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8359With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8360lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8361another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8362order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8363memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8364barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8365looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8366seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8367default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8368
8369@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8370@kindex --plt-localentry
8371@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8372@item --plt-localentry
8373@itemx --no-localentry
8374ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8375ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8376(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8377Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8378or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8379functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8380in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8381interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8382including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8383to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8384complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8385care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8386
8387@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8388@kindex --power10-stubs
8389@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8390@item --power10-stubs
8391@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8392When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8393relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8394linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8395for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8396power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8397power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8398allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8399@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8400auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8401@end table
8402
8403@ifclear GENERIC
8404@lowersections
8405@end ifclear
8406@end ifset
8407
b4cbbe8f
AK
8408@ifset S/390
8409@ifclear GENERIC
8410@raisesections
8411@end ifclear
8412
8413@node S/390 ELF
8414@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8415
8416@cindex S/390 ELF options
8417@table @option
8418
8419@cindex S/390
8420@kindex --s390-pgste
8421@item --s390-pgste
8422This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8423segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8424binaries marked that way.
8425@end table
8426
8427@ifclear GENERIC
8428@lowersections
8429@end ifclear
8430@end ifset
8431
49fa1e15
AM
8432@ifset SPU
8433@ifclear GENERIC
8434@raisesections
8435@end ifclear
8436
8437@node SPU ELF
8438@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8439
8440@cindex SPU ELF options
8441@table @option
8442
8443@cindex SPU plugins
8444@kindex --plugin
8445@item --plugin
8446This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8447
8448@cindex SPU overlays
8449@kindex --no-overlays
8450@item --no-overlays
8451Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8452regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8453@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8454turns off all this special overlay handling.
8455
8456@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8457@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8458@item --emit-stub-syms
8459This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8460symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8461
8462@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8463@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8464@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8465This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8466function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8467on calls to non-overlay regions.
8468
8469@cindex SPU local store size
8470@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8471@item --local-store=lo:hi
8472@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8473the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8474range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8475
c0065db7 8476@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8477@kindex --stack-analysis
8478@item --stack-analysis
8479SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8480unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8481under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8482@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8483@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8484determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8485for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8486for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8487for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8488find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8489and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8490under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8491dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8492is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8493and calls will be given.
8494
c0065db7 8495@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8496@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8497@item --emit-stack-syms
8498This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8499in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8500These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8501functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8502functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8503such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8504The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8505@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8506@end table
8507
8508@ifclear GENERIC
8509@lowersections
8510@end ifclear
8511@end ifset
8512
36f63dca
NC
8513@ifset TICOFF
8514@ifclear GENERIC
8515@raisesections
8516@end ifclear
8517
8518@node TI COFF
8519@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8520@cindex TI COFF versions
8521@kindex --format=@var{version}
8522The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8523TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8524also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8525format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8526header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8527
8528@ifclear GENERIC
8529@lowersections
8530@end ifclear
8531@end ifset
8532
2ca22b03
NC
8533@ifset WIN32
8534@ifclear GENERIC
8535@raisesections
8536@end ifclear
8537
8538@node WIN32
8539@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8540
c0065db7 8541This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8542See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8543command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8544
8545@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8546@cindex import libraries
8547@item import libraries
69da35b5 8548The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8549libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8550regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8551archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8552support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8553@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8554
c0065db7
RM
8555@item exporting DLL symbols
8556@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8557The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8558
8559@table @emph
8560@item using auto-export functionality
8561@cindex using auto-export functionality
8562By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8563which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8564
0a5d968e
NC
8565@itemize
8566@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8567@item --exclude-symbols
8568@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8569@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8570@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8571@end itemize
8572
09e2aba4
DK
8573When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8574(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8575symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8576often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8577private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8578options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8579exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8580final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8581
8582If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8583command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8584if either of the following are true:
8585
8586@itemize
8587@item A DEF file is used.
8588@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8589@end itemize
dc8465bf 8590
c0065db7
RM
8591@item using a DEF file
8592@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8593Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8594an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8595exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8596name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8597command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8598
8599@example
8600gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8601@end example
8602
0a5d968e
NC
8603Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8604@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8605
dc8465bf
NC
8606Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8607
8608@example
4b5bd4e7 8609LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8610
8611EXPORTS
8612foo
8613bar
8614_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8615another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8616var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8617doo = foo == foo2
8618eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8619@end example
dc8465bf 8620
7fcab871 8621This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8622symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8623alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8624by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8625@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8626@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8627export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8628in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8629symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8630
6b31ad16
DS
8631The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8632name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8633the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8634
b45619c0
NC
8635When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8636library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8637@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8638executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8639
8640With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8641specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8642non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8643
8644If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8645or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8646filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8647
4b5bd4e7
DS
8648The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8649
8650@example
8651EXPORTS
8652 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8653 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8654 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8655@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8656
8657Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8658@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8659@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8660@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8661Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8662@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8663string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8664
8665The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8666
8667@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8668will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8669by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8670linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8671library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8672
8673@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8674The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8675the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8676@code{*_imp__foo}).
8677
8678@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8679well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8680read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8681variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8682the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8683extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8684application will behave unexpectedly.
8685
8686@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8687it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8688symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8689API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8690the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8691
4b5bd4e7
DS
8692See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8693other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8694
8695@cindex creating a DEF file
8696While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8697with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8698
8699@item Using decorations
8700@cindex Using decorations
8701Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8702itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8703declared as:
8704
8705@example
8706__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8707__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8708@end example
8709
8710All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8711any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8712this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8713the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8714
8715Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8716decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8717instead:
8718
8719@example
8720__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8721__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8722@end example
8723
c0065db7
RM
8724This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8725when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8726variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8727code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8728of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8729omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8730@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8731information.
c0065db7 8732@end table
dc8465bf 8733
2ca22b03
NC
8734@cindex automatic data imports
8735@item automatic data imports
8736The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8737by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8738compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8739issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8740code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8741c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8742initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8743decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8744platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8745command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8746The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8747suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8748trigger the feature's use.
8749
c0065db7 8750auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8751additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8752
c0065db7 8753"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8754documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8755
c0065db7
RM
8756The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8757occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8758One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8759below.
8760
8761@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8762For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8763object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8764offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8765field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8766in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8767without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8768The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8769references.
8770
c0065db7
RM
8771The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8772be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8773themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8774runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8775compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8776support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8777run without error on an older system.
8778
c0065db7
RM
8779@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8780enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8781
8782@cindex direct linking to a dll
8783@item direct linking to a dll
8784The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8785including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8786libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8787traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8788libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8789function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8790though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8791storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8792tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8793large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8794
c0065db7 8795Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8796@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8797of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8798perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8799select the dll instead of an import library.
8800
2ca22b03 8801
69da35b5
NC
8802For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8803to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8804
8805@example
45e948fe
NC
8806libxxx.dll.a
8807xxx.dll.a
8808libxxx.a
8809xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8810libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8811cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8812libxxx.dll
8813xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8814@end example
8815
69da35b5
NC
8816before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8817
c0065db7
RM
8818(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8819where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8820@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8821file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8822@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8823
c0065db7
RM
8824Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8825@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8826was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8827various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8828could coexist on the same machine.
8829
2ca22b03
NC
8830The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8831applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8832libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8833
8834@example
8835bin/
8836 cygxxx.dll
8837lib/
8838 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8839 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8840@end example
8841
c0065db7
RM
8842Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8843done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8844
88451. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8846@example
8847gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8848@end example
2ca22b03 8849
69da35b5
NC
8850However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8851(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8852@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8853not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8854
2ca22b03
NC
88552. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8856directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8857should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8858making the app/dll.
8859
8860@example
8861ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8862@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8863
8864Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8865
8866@example
8867gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8868@end example
69da35b5
NC
8869
8870This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8871perfectly legal
8872
8873@example
8874bin/
8875 cygxxx-5.dll
8876lib/
c0065db7 8877 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8878@end example
8879
dc8465bf 8880Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8881even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8882@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8883
8884Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8885wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8886
88871. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8888work with auto-imported data.
8889
dc8465bf
NC
88902. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8891import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8892symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8893for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8894possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8895
45e948fe
NC
88963. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8897critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8898in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8899stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8900
69da35b5 8901So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8902true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8903a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8904binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8905massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8906requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8907will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8908
c0065db7 8909@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8910@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8911@item adding additional names
8912Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8913A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8914exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8915when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8916import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8917
c0065db7 8918@example
dc8465bf
NC
8919LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8920
8921EXPORTS
c0065db7 8922foo
dc8465bf 8923_foo = foo
c0065db7 8924@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8925
8926The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8927
8928Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8929source code using the "weak" attribute:
8930
c0065db7
RM
8931@example
8932void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8933void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8934@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8935
8936See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8937symbols.
8938
8939@item renaming symbols
8940Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8941kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8942@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8943DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8944created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8945
c0065db7 8946@example
dc8465bf
NC
8947LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8948
8949EXPORTS
8950_foo = foo
c0065db7 8951@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8952
8953The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8954@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8955@end table
dc8465bf 8956
0a5d968e 8957Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8958unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8959If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8960@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8961that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8962@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8963renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8964to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8965the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8966In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8967which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8968
8969@cindex weak externals
8970@item weak externals
8971The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8972weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8973defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8974are three variants of weak externals:
8975@itemize
8976@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8977called lazy externals.
8978@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8979This form is not presently implemented.
8980@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8981implemented.
8982@end itemize
8983As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8984are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8985uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8986
8987@cindex aligned common symbols
8988@item aligned common symbols
8989As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8990desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8991the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8992carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8993by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8994tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8995but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8996warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8997
2ca22b03
NC
8998@end table
8999
9000@ifclear GENERIC
9001@lowersections
9002@end ifclear
9003@end ifset
9004
e0001a05
NC
9005@ifset XTENSA
9006@ifclear GENERIC
9007@raisesections
9008@end ifclear
9009
9010@node Xtensa
9011@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9012
9013@cindex Xtensa processors
9014The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9015@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9016specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9017keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9018example, with the command:
9019
9020@smallexample
9021SECTIONS
9022@{
9023 .text : @{
9024 *(.literal .text)
9025 @}
9026@}
9027@end smallexample
9028
9029@noindent
9030@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9031and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9032literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9033interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9034group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9035files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9036and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 9037
43cd72b9 9038@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 9039@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
9040Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9041provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9042is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9043literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9044will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9045location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9046the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9047unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9048@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9049range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9050
9051For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9052to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9053instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9054instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9055instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9056@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9057hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9058By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9059switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9060density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9061instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9062performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9063linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9064a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9065
9066The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9067control the linker:
9068
9069@cindex Xtensa options
9070@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9071@item --size-opt
9072When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9073more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9074no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9075alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9076preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9077
9078@item --abi-windowed
9079@itemx --abi-call0
9080Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9081PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9082because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9083conventions.
9084Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9085of the first input object.
9086A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9087or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9088@end table
e0001a05
NC
9089
9090@ifclear GENERIC
9091@lowersections
9092@end ifclear
9093@end ifset
9094
252b5132
RH
9095@ifclear SingleFormat
9096@node BFD
9097@chapter BFD
9098
9099@cindex back end
9100@cindex object file management
9101@cindex object formats available
9102@kindex objdump -i
9103The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9104These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9105object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9106format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9107it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9108associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9109object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9110(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9111list all the formats available for your configuration.
9112
9113@cindex BFD requirements
9114@cindex requirements for BFD
9115As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9116several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9117BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9118formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9119been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9120BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9121may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9122
9123One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9124mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9125useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9126conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9127
9128@menu
9129* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9130@end menu
9131
9132@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9133@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9134@cindex opening object files
9135@include bfdsumm.texi
9136@end ifclear
9137
9138@node Reporting Bugs
9139@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9140@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9141@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9142
ff5dcc92 9143Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9144
9145Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9146it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9147to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9148work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9149@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9150
9151In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9152information that enables us to fix the bug.
9153
9154@menu
9155* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9156* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9157@end menu
9158
9159@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9160@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9161@cindex bug criteria
9162
9163If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9164
9165@itemize @bullet
9166@cindex fatal signal
9167@cindex linker crash
9168@cindex crash of linker
9169@item
9170If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9171@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9172
9173@cindex error on valid input
9174@item
ff5dcc92 9175If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9176
9177@cindex invalid input
9178@item
ff5dcc92 9179If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9180may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9181object files are correct.
9182
9183@item
9184If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9185improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9186@end itemize
9187
9188@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9189@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9190@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9191@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9192
9193A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9194products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9195recommend you contact that organization first.
9196
9197You can find contact information for many support companies and
9198individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9199distribution.
9200
ad22bfe8 9201@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9202Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9203@value{BUGURL}.
9204@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9205
9206The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9207@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9208fact or leave it out, state it!
9209
9210Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9211problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9212assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9213matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9214the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9215location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9216were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9217into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9218specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9219and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9220
9221Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9222the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9223on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9224
9225Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9226bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9227respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9228You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9229
9230To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9231
9232@itemize @bullet
9233@item
ff5dcc92 9234The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9235the @samp{--version} argument.
9236
9237Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9238the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9239
9240@item
ff5dcc92 9241Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9242patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9243
9244@item
9245The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9246version number.
9247
9248@item
ff5dcc92 9249What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9250``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9251
9252@item
9253The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9254observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9255list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9256sufficient.
9257
9258If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9259and then we might not encounter the bug.
9260
9261@item
9262A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9263bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9264provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9265bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9266state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9267requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9268we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9269attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9270
9271If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9272@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9273object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9274@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9275how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9276
9277@item
9278A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9279incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9280
ff5dcc92 9281Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9282will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9283not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9284a chance to make a mistake.
9285
9286Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9287say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9288copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9289C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9290and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9291fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9292you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9293any conclusion from our observations.
9294
9295@item
ff5dcc92 9296If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9297diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9298@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9299If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9300context, not by line number.
9301
9302The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9303sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9304@end itemize
9305
9306Here are some things that are not necessary:
9307
9308@itemize @bullet
9309@item
9310A description of the envelope of the bug.
9311
9312Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9313which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9314changes will not affect it.
9315
9316This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9317will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9318with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9319We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9320
9321Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9322of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9323output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9324less time, and so on.
9325
9326However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9327report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9328
9329@item
9330A patch for the bug.
9331
9332A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9333the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9334a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9335to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9336
ff5dcc92 9337Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9338construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9339through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9340able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9341fixed.
9342
9343And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9344patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9345help us to understand.
9346
9347@item
9348A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9349
9350Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9351things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9352@end itemize
9353
9354@node MRI
9355@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9356@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9357To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9358linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9359alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9360described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9361simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9362@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9363linker commands; these commands are described here.
9364
9365In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9366file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9367features to make use of them.
9368
9369You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9370@samp{-c} command-line option.
9371
9372Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9373command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9374blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9375MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9376issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9377
9378Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9379
9380You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9381lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9382The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9383
9384@table @code
9385@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9386@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9387@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9388Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9389the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9390@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9391your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9392script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9393commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9394input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9395@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9396
9397@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9398@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9399Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9400in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9401
9402@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9403
9404@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9405@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9406Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9407@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9408
9409@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9410@item BASE @var{expression}
9411Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9412absolute addresses) in the output file.
9413
9414@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9415@item CHIP @var{expression}
9416@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9417This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9418
9419@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9420@item END
9421This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9422
9423@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9424@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9425Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9426language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9427
9428@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9429@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9430Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9431@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9432
9433The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9434same line, with no change in its effect.
9435
9436@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9437@item LOAD @var{filename}
9438@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9439Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9440same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9441command line.
9442
9443@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9444@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9445@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9446MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9447option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9448
9449@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9450@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9451@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9452Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9453order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9454script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9455sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9456file, in the order specified.
9457
9458@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9459@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9460@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9461@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9462Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9463@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9464
9465@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9466@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9467@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9468@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9469You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9470specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9471If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9472@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9473@end table
9474
793c5807
NC
9475@node GNU Free Documentation License
9476@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9477@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9478
370b66a1
CD
9479@node LD Index
9480@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9481
9482@printindex cp
9483
9484@tex
7ca01ed9 9485% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9486% meantime:
9487\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9488\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9489\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9490\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9491\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9492\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9493\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9494\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9495\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9496% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9497@end tex
9498
252b5132 9499@bye